blob: da033dc66f2969b6ce78e97f183c5d2f668d3cff [file] [log] [blame]
Tom Rini10e47792018-05-06 17:58:06 -04001# SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0+
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002#
Wolfgang Denk1234ce72013-06-21 10:22:36 +02003# (C) Copyright 2000 - 2013
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004# Wolfgang Denk, DENX Software Engineering, wd@denx.de.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005
6Summary:
7========
8
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00009This directory contains the source code for U-Boot, a boot loader for
wdenkce4832c2004-10-17 21:12:06 +000010Embedded boards based on PowerPC, ARM, MIPS and several other
11processors, which can be installed in a boot ROM and used to
12initialize and test the hardware or to download and run application
13code.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000014
15The development of U-Boot is closely related to Linux: some parts of
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000016the source code originate in the Linux source tree, we have some
17header files in common, and special provision has been made to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000018support booting of Linux images.
19
20Some attention has been paid to make this software easily
21configurable and extendable. For instance, all monitor commands are
22implemented with the same call interface, so that it's very easy to
23add new commands. Also, instead of permanently adding rarely used
24code (for instance hardware test utilities) to the monitor, you can
25load and run it dynamically.
26
27
28Status:
29=======
30
31In general, all boards for which a configuration option exists in the
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000032Makefile have been tested to some extent and can be considered
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000033"working". In fact, many of them are used in production systems.
34
Robert P. J. Day076ed9b2015-12-19 07:16:10 -050035In case of problems see the CHANGELOG file to find out who contributed
36the specific port. In addition, there are various MAINTAINERS files
37scattered throughout the U-Boot source identifying the people or
38companies responsible for various boards and subsystems.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000039
Robert P. J. Day076ed9b2015-12-19 07:16:10 -050040Note: As of August, 2010, there is no longer a CHANGELOG file in the
41actual U-Boot source tree; however, it can be created dynamically
42from the Git log using:
Robert P. J. Day974ed2f2012-11-14 02:03:20 +000043
44 make CHANGELOG
45
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000046
47Where to get help:
48==================
49
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000050In case you have questions about, problems with or contributions for
Robert P. J. Day076ed9b2015-12-19 07:16:10 -050051U-Boot, you should send a message to the U-Boot mailing list at
Peter Tyser8804a612008-09-10 09:18:34 -050052<u-boot@lists.denx.de>. There is also an archive of previous traffic
53on the mailing list - please search the archive before asking FAQ's.
54Please see http://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot and
55http://dir.gmane.org/gmane.comp.boot-loaders.u-boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000056
57
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +010058Where to get source code:
59=========================
60
Robert P. J. Day076ed9b2015-12-19 07:16:10 -050061The U-Boot source code is maintained in the Git repository at
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +010062git://www.denx.de/git/u-boot.git ; you can browse it online at
63http://www.denx.de/cgi-bin/gitweb.cgi?p=u-boot.git;a=summary
64
65The "snapshot" links on this page allow you to download tarballs of
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +020066any version you might be interested in. Official releases are also
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +010067available for FTP download from the ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/
68directory.
69
Anatolij Gustschin08337f32008-03-26 18:13:33 +010070Pre-built (and tested) images are available from
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +010071ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/images/
72
73
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000074Where we come from:
75===================
76
77- start from 8xxrom sources
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000078- create PPCBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/ppcboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000079- clean up code
80- make it easier to add custom boards
81- make it possible to add other [PowerPC] CPUs
82- extend functions, especially:
83 * Provide extended interface to Linux boot loader
84 * S-Record download
85 * network boot
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +020086 * PCMCIA / CompactFlash / ATA disk / SCSI ... boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000087- create ARMBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/armboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000088- add other CPU families (starting with ARM)
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000089- create U-Boot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/u-boot)
Magnus Liljaf3b287b2008-08-06 19:32:33 +020090- current project page: see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000091
92
93Names and Spelling:
94===================
95
96The "official" name of this project is "Das U-Boot". The spelling
97"U-Boot" shall be used in all written text (documentation, comments
98in source files etc.). Example:
99
100 This is the README file for the U-Boot project.
101
102File names etc. shall be based on the string "u-boot". Examples:
103
104 include/asm-ppc/u-boot.h
105
106 #include <asm/u-boot.h>
107
108Variable names, preprocessor constants etc. shall be either based on
109the string "u_boot" or on "U_BOOT". Example:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000110
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +0000111 U_BOOT_VERSION u_boot_logo
112 IH_OS_U_BOOT u_boot_hush_start
113
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000114
wdenk7474aca2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000115Versioning:
116===========
117
Thomas Webere89e6282010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200118Starting with the release in October 2008, the names of the releases
119were changed from numerical release numbers without deeper meaning
120into a time stamp based numbering. Regular releases are identified by
121names consisting of the calendar year and month of the release date.
122Additional fields (if present) indicate release candidates or bug fix
123releases in "stable" maintenance trees.
wdenk7474aca2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000124
Thomas Webere89e6282010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200125Examples:
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +0000126 U-Boot v2009.11 - Release November 2009
Thomas Webere89e6282010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200127 U-Boot v2009.11.1 - Release 1 in version November 2009 stable tree
Jelle van der Waa30245ca2016-10-30 17:30:30 +0100128 U-Boot v2010.09-rc1 - Release candidate 1 for September 2010 release
wdenk7474aca2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000129
130
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000131Directory Hierarchy:
132====================
133
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500134/arch Architecture specific files
Masahiro Yamadaef6ebff2014-03-07 18:02:02 +0900135 /arc Files generic to ARC architecture
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500136 /arm Files generic to ARM architecture
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500137 /m68k Files generic to m68k architecture
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500138 /microblaze Files generic to microblaze architecture
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500139 /mips Files generic to MIPS architecture
Macpaul Lin1cac36e2011-10-19 20:41:11 +0000140 /nds32 Files generic to NDS32 architecture
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500141 /nios2 Files generic to Altera NIOS2 architecture
Robert P. J. Daya269c932013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400142 /openrisc Files generic to OpenRISC architecture
Stefan Roese88fbf932010-04-15 16:07:28 +0200143 /powerpc Files generic to PowerPC architecture
Rick Chend7e6f922017-12-26 13:55:59 +0800144 /riscv Files generic to RISC-V architecture
Robert P. J. Day076ed9b2015-12-19 07:16:10 -0500145 /sandbox Files generic to HW-independent "sandbox"
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500146 /sh Files generic to SH architecture
Robert P. J. Daya269c932013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400147 /x86 Files generic to x86 architecture
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500148/api Machine/arch independent API for external apps
149/board Board dependent files
Xu Ziyuanfb1f9392016-08-26 19:54:49 +0800150/cmd U-Boot commands functions
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500151/common Misc architecture independent functions
Robert P. J. Day076ed9b2015-12-19 07:16:10 -0500152/configs Board default configuration files
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500153/disk Code for disk drive partition handling
154/doc Documentation (don't expect too much)
155/drivers Commonly used device drivers
Robert P. J. Daya269c932013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400156/dts Contains Makefile for building internal U-Boot fdt.
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500157/examples Example code for standalone applications, etc.
158/fs Filesystem code (cramfs, ext2, jffs2, etc.)
159/include Header Files
Robert P. J. Day076ed9b2015-12-19 07:16:10 -0500160/lib Library routines generic to all architectures
161/Licenses Various license files
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500162/net Networking code
163/post Power On Self Test
Robert P. J. Day076ed9b2015-12-19 07:16:10 -0500164/scripts Various build scripts and Makefiles
165/test Various unit test files
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500166/tools Tools to build S-Record or U-Boot images, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000167
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000168Software Configuration:
169=======================
170
171Configuration is usually done using C preprocessor defines; the
172rationale behind that is to avoid dead code whenever possible.
173
174There are two classes of configuration variables:
175
176* Configuration _OPTIONS_:
177 These are selectable by the user and have names beginning with
178 "CONFIG_".
179
180* Configuration _SETTINGS_:
181 These depend on the hardware etc. and should not be meddled with if
182 you don't know what you're doing; they have names beginning with
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200183 "CONFIG_SYS_".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000184
Robert P. J. Day076ed9b2015-12-19 07:16:10 -0500185Previously, all configuration was done by hand, which involved creating
186symbolic links and editing configuration files manually. More recently,
187U-Boot has added the Kbuild infrastructure used by the Linux kernel,
188allowing you to use the "make menuconfig" command to configure your
189build.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000190
191
192Selection of Processor Architecture and Board Type:
193---------------------------------------------------
194
195For all supported boards there are ready-to-use default
Holger Freyther7ba4e572014-08-04 09:26:05 +0200196configurations available; just type "make <board_name>_defconfig".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000197
198Example: For a TQM823L module type:
199
200 cd u-boot
Holger Freyther7ba4e572014-08-04 09:26:05 +0200201 make TQM823L_defconfig
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000202
Robert P. J. Day076ed9b2015-12-19 07:16:10 -0500203Note: If you're looking for the default configuration file for a board
204you're sure used to be there but is now missing, check the file
205doc/README.scrapyard for a list of no longer supported boards.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000206
Simon Glass53552c92014-03-22 17:12:59 -0600207Sandbox Environment:
208--------------------
209
210U-Boot can be built natively to run on a Linux host using the 'sandbox'
211board. This allows feature development which is not board- or architecture-
212specific to be undertaken on a native platform. The sandbox is also used to
213run some of U-Boot's tests.
214
Jagannadha Sutradharudu Teki287314f2014-08-31 21:19:43 +0530215See board/sandbox/README.sandbox for more details.
Simon Glass53552c92014-03-22 17:12:59 -0600216
217
Simon Glassd8711af2015-03-03 08:03:00 -0700218Board Initialisation Flow:
219--------------------------
220
221This is the intended start-up flow for boards. This should apply for both
Robert P. J. Day076ed9b2015-12-19 07:16:10 -0500222SPL and U-Boot proper (i.e. they both follow the same rules).
223
224Note: "SPL" stands for "Secondary Program Loader," which is explained in
225more detail later in this file.
226
227At present, SPL mostly uses a separate code path, but the function names
228and roles of each function are the same. Some boards or architectures
229may not conform to this. At least most ARM boards which use
230CONFIG_SPL_FRAMEWORK conform to this.
Simon Glassd8711af2015-03-03 08:03:00 -0700231
Robert P. J. Day076ed9b2015-12-19 07:16:10 -0500232Execution typically starts with an architecture-specific (and possibly
233CPU-specific) start.S file, such as:
234
235 - arch/arm/cpu/armv7/start.S
236 - arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc83xx/start.S
237 - arch/mips/cpu/start.S
238
239and so on. From there, three functions are called; the purpose and
240limitations of each of these functions are described below.
Simon Glassd8711af2015-03-03 08:03:00 -0700241
242lowlevel_init():
243 - purpose: essential init to permit execution to reach board_init_f()
244 - no global_data or BSS
245 - there is no stack (ARMv7 may have one but it will soon be removed)
246 - must not set up SDRAM or use console
247 - must only do the bare minimum to allow execution to continue to
248 board_init_f()
249 - this is almost never needed
250 - return normally from this function
251
252board_init_f():
253 - purpose: set up the machine ready for running board_init_r():
254 i.e. SDRAM and serial UART
255 - global_data is available
256 - stack is in SRAM
257 - BSS is not available, so you cannot use global/static variables,
258 only stack variables and global_data
259
260 Non-SPL-specific notes:
261 - dram_init() is called to set up DRAM. If already done in SPL this
262 can do nothing
263
264 SPL-specific notes:
265 - you can override the entire board_init_f() function with your own
266 version as needed.
267 - preloader_console_init() can be called here in extremis
268 - should set up SDRAM, and anything needed to make the UART work
269 - these is no need to clear BSS, it will be done by crt0.S
270 - must return normally from this function (don't call board_init_r()
271 directly)
272
273Here the BSS is cleared. For SPL, if CONFIG_SPL_STACK_R is defined, then at
274this point the stack and global_data are relocated to below
275CONFIG_SPL_STACK_R_ADDR. For non-SPL, U-Boot is relocated to run at the top of
276memory.
277
278board_init_r():
279 - purpose: main execution, common code
280 - global_data is available
281 - SDRAM is available
282 - BSS is available, all static/global variables can be used
283 - execution eventually continues to main_loop()
284
285 Non-SPL-specific notes:
286 - U-Boot is relocated to the top of memory and is now running from
287 there.
288
289 SPL-specific notes:
290 - stack is optionally in SDRAM, if CONFIG_SPL_STACK_R is defined and
291 CONFIG_SPL_STACK_R_ADDR points into SDRAM
292 - preloader_console_init() can be called here - typically this is
Ley Foon Tan48fcc4a2017-05-03 17:13:32 +0800293 done by selecting CONFIG_SPL_BOARD_INIT and then supplying a
Simon Glassd8711af2015-03-03 08:03:00 -0700294 spl_board_init() function containing this call
295 - loads U-Boot or (in falcon mode) Linux
296
297
298
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000299Configuration Options:
300----------------------
301
302Configuration depends on the combination of board and CPU type; all
303such information is kept in a configuration file
304"include/configs/<board_name>.h".
305
306Example: For a TQM823L module, all configuration settings are in
307"include/configs/TQM823L.h".
308
309
wdenk1272e232002-11-10 22:06:23 +0000310Many of the options are named exactly as the corresponding Linux
311kernel configuration options. The intention is to make it easier to
312build a config tool - later.
313
Ashish Kumar11234062017-08-11 11:09:14 +0530314- ARM Platform Bus Type(CCI):
315 CoreLink Cache Coherent Interconnect (CCI) is ARM BUS which
316 provides full cache coherency between two clusters of multi-core
317 CPUs and I/O coherency for devices and I/O masters
318
319 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_HAS_CCI400
320
321 Defined For SoC that has cache coherent interconnect
322 CCN-400
wdenk1272e232002-11-10 22:06:23 +0000323
Ashish Kumar97393d62017-08-18 10:54:36 +0530324 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_HAS_CCN504
325
326 Defined for SoC that has cache coherent interconnect CCN-504
327
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000328The following options need to be configured:
329
Kim Phillips203fee32007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500330- CPU Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC85XX.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000331
Kim Phillips203fee32007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500332- Board Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC8540ADS.
Wolfgang Denk994ad962006-10-24 14:42:37 +0200333
Kumar Galaf4fb90f2011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600334- 85xx CPU Options:
York Sun2394a0f2012-10-08 07:44:30 +0000335 CONFIG_SYS_PPC64
336
337 Specifies that the core is a 64-bit PowerPC implementation (implements
338 the "64" category of the Power ISA). This is necessary for ePAPR
339 compliance, among other possible reasons.
340
Kumar Galaf4fb90f2011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600341 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_TBCLK_DIV
342
343 Defines the core time base clock divider ratio compared to the
344 system clock. On most PQ3 devices this is 8, on newer QorIQ
345 devices it can be 16 or 32. The ratio varies from SoC to Soc.
346
Kumar Gala179b1b22011-05-20 00:39:21 -0500347 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PCIE_COMPAT
348
349 Defines the string to utilize when trying to match PCIe device
350 tree nodes for the given platform.
351
Scott Wood80806962012-08-14 10:14:53 +0000352 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510
353
354 Enables a workaround for erratum A004510. If set,
355 then CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV and
356 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY must be set.
357
358 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV
359 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV2 (optional)
360
361 Defines one or two SoC revisions (low 8 bits of SVR)
362 for which the A004510 workaround should be applied.
363
364 The rest of SVR is either not relevant to the decision
365 of whether the erratum is present (e.g. p2040 versus
366 p2041) or is implied by the build target, which controls
367 whether CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510 is set.
368
369 See Freescale App Note 4493 for more information about
370 this erratum.
371
Prabhakar Kushwahad324f472013-04-16 13:27:44 +0530372 CONFIG_A003399_NOR_WORKAROUND
373 Enables a workaround for IFC erratum A003399. It is only
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -0800374 required during NOR boot.
Prabhakar Kushwahad324f472013-04-16 13:27:44 +0530375
Prabhakar Kushwahac4c10d12014-10-29 22:33:09 +0530376 CONFIG_A008044_WORKAROUND
377 Enables a workaround for T1040/T1042 erratum A008044. It is only
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -0800378 required during NAND boot and valid for Rev 1.0 SoC revision
Prabhakar Kushwahac4c10d12014-10-29 22:33:09 +0530379
Scott Wood80806962012-08-14 10:14:53 +0000380 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY
381
382 This is the value to write into CCSR offset 0x18600
383 according to the A004510 workaround.
384
Priyanka Jainc73b9032013-07-02 09:21:04 +0530385 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_DDR_ADDR
386 This value denotes start offset of DDR memory which is
387 connected exclusively to the DSP cores.
388
Priyanka Jainf81e8b22013-04-04 09:31:54 +0530389 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_M2_RAM_ADDR
390 This value denotes start offset of M2 memory
391 which is directly connected to the DSP core.
392
Priyanka Jainc73b9032013-07-02 09:21:04 +0530393 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_M3_RAM_ADDR
394 This value denotes start offset of M3 memory which is directly
395 connected to the DSP core.
396
Priyanka Jainf81e8b22013-04-04 09:31:54 +0530397 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT
398 This value denotes start offset of DSP CCSR space.
399
Priyanka Jaine9dcaa82013-12-17 14:25:52 +0530400 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_SINGLE_SOURCE_CLK
401 Single Source Clock is clocking mode present in some of FSL SoC's.
402 In this mode, a single differential clock is used to supply
403 clocks to the sysclock, ddrclock and usbclock.
404
Aneesh Bansal8bcbc272014-03-18 23:40:26 +0530405 CONFIG_SYS_CPC_REINIT_F
406 This CONFIG is defined when the CPC is configured as SRAM at the
Bin Meng75574052016-02-05 19:30:11 -0800407 time of U-Boot entry and is required to be re-initialized.
Aneesh Bansal8bcbc272014-03-18 23:40:26 +0530408
Tang Yuantiana7364af2014-04-17 15:33:46 +0800409 CONFIG_DEEP_SLEEP
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -0800410 Indicates this SoC supports deep sleep feature. If deep sleep is
Tang Yuantiana7364af2014-04-17 15:33:46 +0800411 supported, core will start to execute uboot when wakes up.
412
Daniel Schwierzeckd8a49ca2012-04-02 02:57:56 +0000413- Generic CPU options:
414 CONFIG_SYS_BIG_ENDIAN, CONFIG_SYS_LITTLE_ENDIAN
415
416 Defines the endianess of the CPU. Implementation of those
417 values is arch specific.
418
York Sunf0626592013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700419 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR
420 Freescale DDR driver in use. This type of DDR controller is
421 found in mpc83xx, mpc85xx, mpc86xx as well as some ARM core
422 SoCs.
423
424 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_ADDR
425 Freescale DDR memory-mapped register base.
426
427 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_EMU
428 Specify emulator support for DDR. Some DDR features such as
429 deskew training are not available.
430
431 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN1
432 Freescale DDR1 controller.
433
434 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN2
435 Freescale DDR2 controller.
436
437 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN3
438 Freescale DDR3 controller.
439
York Sun2896cb72014-03-27 17:54:47 -0700440 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN4
441 Freescale DDR4 controller.
442
York Sun461c9392013-09-30 14:20:51 -0700443 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_ARM_GEN3
444 Freescale DDR3 controller for ARM-based SoCs.
445
York Sunf0626592013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700446 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR1
447 Board config to use DDR1. It can be enabled for SoCs with
448 Freescale DDR1 or DDR2 controllers, depending on the board
449 implemetation.
450
451 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR2
Robert P. J. Day8d56db92016-07-15 13:44:45 -0400452 Board config to use DDR2. It can be enabled for SoCs with
York Sunf0626592013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700453 Freescale DDR2 or DDR3 controllers, depending on the board
454 implementation.
455
456 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR3
457 Board config to use DDR3. It can be enabled for SoCs with
York Sun2896cb72014-03-27 17:54:47 -0700458 Freescale DDR3 or DDR3L controllers.
459
460 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR3L
461 Board config to use DDR3L. It can be enabled for SoCs with
462 DDR3L controllers.
463
464 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR4
465 Board config to use DDR4. It can be enabled for SoCs with
466 DDR4 controllers.
York Sunf0626592013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700467
Prabhakar Kushwaha62908c22014-01-18 12:28:30 +0530468 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_IFC_BE
469 Defines the IFC controller register space as Big Endian
470
471 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_IFC_LE
472 Defines the IFC controller register space as Little Endian
473
Prabhakar Kushwaha3c48f582017-02-02 15:01:26 +0530474 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_IFC_CLK_DIV
475 Defines divider of platform clock(clock input to IFC controller).
476
Prabhakar Kushwahabedc5622017-02-02 15:02:00 +0530477 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_LBC_CLK_DIV
478 Defines divider of platform clock(clock input to eLBC controller).
479
Prabhakar Kushwaha950f2f72014-01-13 11:28:04 +0530480 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PBL_PBI
481 It enables addition of RCW (Power on reset configuration) in built image.
482 Please refer doc/README.pblimage for more details
483
484 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PBL_RCW
485 It adds PBI(pre-boot instructions) commands in u-boot build image.
486 PBI commands can be used to configure SoC before it starts the execution.
487 Please refer doc/README.pblimage for more details
488
Prabhakar Kushwaha2c27f122014-04-08 19:13:34 +0530489 CONFIG_SPL_FSL_PBL
490 It adds a target to create boot binary having SPL binary in PBI format
491 concatenated with u-boot binary.
492
York Sun29647ab2014-02-10 13:59:42 -0800493 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_BE
494 Defines the DDR controller register space as Big Endian
495
496 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_LE
497 Defines the DDR controller register space as Little Endian
498
York Sun3a0916d2014-02-10 13:59:43 -0800499 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_SDRAM_BASE_PHY
500 Physical address from the view of DDR controllers. It is the
501 same as CONFIG_SYS_DDR_SDRAM_BASE for all Power SoCs. But
502 it could be different for ARM SoCs.
503
York Sunc459ae62014-02-10 13:59:44 -0800504 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_INTLV_256B
505 DDR controller interleaving on 256-byte. This is a special
506 interleaving mode, handled by Dickens for Freescale layerscape
507 SoCs with ARM core.
508
York Sun79a779b2014-08-01 15:51:00 -0700509 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_MAIN_NUM_CTRLS
510 Number of controllers used as main memory.
511
512 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_OTHER_DDR_NUM_CTRLS
513 Number of controllers used for other than main memory.
514
Prabhakar Kushwaha122bcfd2015-11-09 16:42:07 +0530515 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_HAS_DP_DDR
516 Defines the SoC has DP-DDR used for DPAA.
517
Ruchika Guptabb7143b2014-09-09 11:50:31 +0530518 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_SEC_BE
519 Defines the SEC controller register space as Big Endian
520
521 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_SEC_LE
522 Defines the SEC controller register space as Little Endian
523
Daniel Schwierzeckd52a6232011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200524- MIPS CPU options:
525 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_SP_OFFSET
526
527 Offset relative to CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE for initial stack
528 pointer. This is needed for the temporary stack before
529 relocation.
530
Daniel Schwierzeckd52a6232011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200531 CONFIG_XWAY_SWAP_BYTES
532
533 Enable compilation of tools/xway-swap-bytes needed for Lantiq
534 XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash. The U-Boot image needs to
535 be swapped if a flash programmer is used.
536
Christian Riesch48c2d6d2012-02-02 00:44:39 +0000537- ARM options:
538 CONFIG_SYS_EXCEPTION_VECTORS_HIGH
539
540 Select high exception vectors of the ARM core, e.g., do not
541 clear the V bit of the c1 register of CP15.
542
York Sun77a10972015-03-20 19:28:08 -0700543 COUNTER_FREQUENCY
544 Generic timer clock source frequency.
545
546 COUNTER_FREQUENCY_REAL
547 Generic timer clock source frequency if the real clock is
548 different from COUNTER_FREQUENCY, and can only be determined
549 at run time.
550
Stephen Warren8d1fb312015-01-19 16:25:52 -0700551- Tegra SoC options:
552 CONFIG_TEGRA_SUPPORT_NON_SECURE
553
554 Support executing U-Boot in non-secure (NS) mode. Certain
555 impossible actions will be skipped if the CPU is in NS mode,
556 such as ARM architectural timer initialization.
557
wdenk9b7f3842003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000558- Linux Kernel Interface:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000559 CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ
560
561 U-Boot stores all clock information in Hz
562 internally. For binary compatibility with older Linux
563 kernels (which expect the clocks passed in the
564 bd_info data to be in MHz) the environment variable
565 "clocks_in_mhz" can be defined so that U-Boot
566 converts clock data to MHZ before passing it to the
567 Linux kernel.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000568 When CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ is defined, a definition of
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +0100569 "clocks_in_mhz=1" is automatically included in the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000570 default environment.
571
wdenk9b7f3842003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000572 CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES [relevant for MIPS only]
573
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -0800574 When transferring memsize parameter to Linux, some versions
wdenk9b7f3842003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000575 expect it to be in bytes, others in MB.
576 Define CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES to make it in bytes.
577
Gerald Van Barenfcd91bb2008-06-03 20:34:45 -0400578 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
Wolfgang Denk27a5b0b2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200579
580 New kernel versions are expecting firmware settings to be
Gerald Van Barend6abef42007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400581 passed using flattened device trees (based on open firmware
582 concepts).
583
584 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
585 * New libfdt-based support
586 * Adds the "fdt" command
Kim Phillips9b46eb62007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500587 * The bootm command automatically updates the fdt
Gerald Van Barend6abef42007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400588
Wolfgang Denk27a5b0b2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200589 OF_TBCLK - The timebase frequency.
Kumar Galae40c2b52006-01-11 13:59:02 -0600590 OF_STDOUT_PATH - The path to the console device
Wolfgang Denk27a5b0b2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200591
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200592 boards with QUICC Engines require OF_QE to set UCC MAC
593 addresses
Kim Phillips9b46eb62007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500594
Kumar Gala1e26aa52006-01-11 13:54:17 -0600595 CONFIG_OF_BOARD_SETUP
596
597 Board code has addition modification that it wants to make
598 to the flat device tree before handing it off to the kernel
wdenkda04a8b2004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000599
Simon Glass6c0be912014-10-23 18:58:54 -0600600 CONFIG_OF_SYSTEM_SETUP
601
602 Other code has addition modification that it wants to make
603 to the flat device tree before handing it off to the kernel.
604 This causes ft_system_setup() to be called before booting
605 the kernel.
606
Heiko Schocherffb293a2009-09-23 07:56:08 +0200607 CONFIG_OF_IDE_FIXUP
608
609 U-Boot can detect if an IDE device is present or not.
610 If not, and this new config option is activated, U-Boot
611 removes the ATA node from the DTS before booting Linux,
612 so the Linux IDE driver does not probe the device and
613 crash. This is needed for buggy hardware (uc101) where
614 no pull down resistor is connected to the signal IDE5V_DD7.
615
Igor Grinberg06890672011-07-14 05:45:07 +0000616 CONFIG_MACH_TYPE [relevant for ARM only][mandatory]
617
618 This setting is mandatory for all boards that have only one
619 machine type and must be used to specify the machine type
620 number as it appears in the ARM machine registry
621 (see http://www.arm.linux.org.uk/developer/machines/).
622 Only boards that have multiple machine types supported
623 in a single configuration file and the machine type is
624 runtime discoverable, do not have to use this setting.
625
Niklaus Giger0ab978d2008-11-03 22:13:47 +0100626- vxWorks boot parameters:
627
628 bootvx constructs a valid bootline using the following
Bin Mengfb694b92015-10-07 20:19:17 -0700629 environments variables: bootdev, bootfile, ipaddr, netmask,
630 serverip, gatewayip, hostname, othbootargs.
Niklaus Giger0ab978d2008-11-03 22:13:47 +0100631 It loads the vxWorks image pointed bootfile.
632
Niklaus Giger0ab978d2008-11-03 22:13:47 +0100633 Note: If a "bootargs" environment is defined, it will overwride
634 the defaults discussed just above.
635
Aneesh V960f5c02011-06-16 23:30:47 +0000636- Cache Configuration:
637 CONFIG_SYS_ICACHE_OFF - Do not enable instruction cache in U-Boot
638 CONFIG_SYS_DCACHE_OFF - Do not enable data cache in U-Boot
639 CONFIG_SYS_L2CACHE_OFF- Do not enable L2 cache in U-Boot
640
Aneesh V686a0752011-06-16 23:30:51 +0000641- Cache Configuration for ARM:
642 CONFIG_SYS_L2_PL310 - Enable support for ARM PL310 L2 cache
643 controller
644 CONFIG_SYS_PL310_BASE - Physical base address of PL310
645 controller register space
646
wdenkda04a8b2004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000647- Serial Ports:
Andreas Engel0813b122008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200648 CONFIG_PL010_SERIAL
wdenkda04a8b2004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000649
650 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL010 UARTs.
651
Andreas Engel0813b122008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200652 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL
wdenkda04a8b2004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000653
654 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs.
655
656 CONFIG_PL011_CLOCK
657
658 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs, set this variable to
659 the clock speed of the UARTs.
660
661 CONFIG_PL01x_PORTS
662
663 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL010 or PL011 UARTs on your board,
664 define this to a list of base addresses for each (supported)
665 port. See e.g. include/configs/versatile.h
666
Karicheri, Muralidharancbc08882014-04-09 15:38:46 -0400667 CONFIG_SERIAL_HW_FLOW_CONTROL
668
669 Define this variable to enable hw flow control in serial driver.
670 Current user of this option is drivers/serial/nsl16550.c driver
wdenkda04a8b2004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000671
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000672- Console Baudrate:
673 CONFIG_BAUDRATE - in bps
674 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200675 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000676
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000677- Autoboot Command:
678 CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
679 Only needed when CONFIG_BOOTDELAY is enabled;
680 define a command string that is automatically executed
681 when no character is read on the console interface
682 within "Boot Delay" after reset.
683
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000684 CONFIG_RAMBOOT and CONFIG_NFSBOOT
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000685 The value of these goes into the environment as
686 "ramboot" and "nfsboot" respectively, and can be used
687 as a convenience, when switching between booting from
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200688 RAM and NFS.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000689
690- Pre-Boot Commands:
691 CONFIG_PREBOOT
692
693 When this option is #defined, the existence of the
694 environment variable "preboot" will be checked
695 immediately before starting the CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
696 countdown and/or running the auto-boot command resp.
697 entering interactive mode.
698
699 This feature is especially useful when "preboot" is
700 automatically generated or modified. For an example
701 see the LWMON board specific code: here "preboot" is
702 modified when the user holds down a certain
703 combination of keys on the (special) keyboard when
704 booting the systems
705
706- Serial Download Echo Mode:
707 CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
708 If defined to 1, all characters received during a
709 serial download (using the "loads" command) are
710 echoed back. This might be needed by some terminal
711 emulations (like "cu"), but may as well just take
712 time on others. This setting #define's the initial
713 value of the "loads_echo" environment variable.
714
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500715- Kgdb Serial Baudrate: (if CONFIG_CMD_KGDB is defined)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000716 CONFIG_KGDB_BAUDRATE
717 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200718 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000719
Simon Glassaa34ef22016-03-13 19:07:28 -0600720- Removal of commands
721 If no commands are needed to boot, you can disable
722 CONFIG_CMDLINE to remove them. In this case, the command line
723 will not be available, and when U-Boot wants to execute the
724 boot command (on start-up) it will call board_run_command()
725 instead. This can reduce image size significantly for very
726 simple boot procedures.
727
Wolfgang Denk2aceea12013-03-23 23:50:31 +0000728- Regular expression support:
729 CONFIG_REGEX
Wolfgang Denkec7fbf52013-10-04 17:43:24 +0200730 If this variable is defined, U-Boot is linked against
731 the SLRE (Super Light Regular Expression) library,
732 which adds regex support to some commands, as for
733 example "env grep" and "setexpr".
Wolfgang Denk2aceea12013-03-23 23:50:31 +0000734
Simon Glass3d686442011-10-15 05:48:20 +0000735- Device tree:
736 CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
737 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will use a device tree
738 to configure its devices, instead of relying on statically
739 compiled #defines in the board file. This option is
740 experimental and only available on a few boards. The device
741 tree is available in the global data as gd->fdt_blob.
742
Simon Glass5cb34db2011-10-24 19:15:31 +0000743 U-Boot needs to get its device tree from somewhere. This can
Alex Deymo5b661ec2017-04-02 01:25:20 -0700744 be done using one of the three options below:
Simon Glass38d6b8d2011-10-15 05:48:21 +0000745
746 CONFIG_OF_EMBED
747 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will embed a device tree
748 binary in its image. This device tree file should be in the
749 board directory and called <soc>-<board>.dts. The binary file
750 is then picked up in board_init_f() and made available through
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu1f17f192017-08-26 07:34:14 +0900751 the global data structure as gd->fdt_blob.
Simon Glass3d686442011-10-15 05:48:20 +0000752
Simon Glass5cb34db2011-10-24 19:15:31 +0000753 CONFIG_OF_SEPARATE
754 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will build a device tree
755 binary. It will be called u-boot.dtb. Architecture-specific
756 code will locate it at run-time. Generally this works by:
757
758 cat u-boot.bin u-boot.dtb >image.bin
759
760 and in fact, U-Boot does this for you, creating a file called
761 u-boot-dtb.bin which is useful in the common case. You can
762 still use the individual files if you need something more
763 exotic.
764
Alex Deymo5b661ec2017-04-02 01:25:20 -0700765 CONFIG_OF_BOARD
766 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will use the device tree
767 provided by the board at runtime instead of embedding one with
768 the image. Only boards defining board_fdt_blob_setup() support
769 this option (see include/fdtdec.h file).
770
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000771- Watchdog:
772 CONFIG_WATCHDOG
773 If this variable is defined, it enables watchdog
Detlev Zundel6aa4d7b2011-04-27 05:25:59 +0000774 support for the SoC. There must be support in the SoC
Christophe Leroy069fa832017-07-06 10:23:22 +0200775 specific code for a watchdog. For the 8xx
776 CPUs, the SIU Watchdog feature is enabled in the SYPCR
777 register. When supported for a specific SoC is
778 available, then no further board specific code should
779 be needed to use it.
Detlev Zundel6aa4d7b2011-04-27 05:25:59 +0000780
781 CONFIG_HW_WATCHDOG
782 When using a watchdog circuitry external to the used
783 SoC, then define this variable and provide board
784 specific code for the "hw_watchdog_reset" function.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000785
Heiko Schocher735326c2015-01-21 08:38:22 +0100786 CONFIG_AT91_HW_WDT_TIMEOUT
787 specify the timeout in seconds. default 2 seconds.
788
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000789- Real-Time Clock:
790
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500791 When CONFIG_CMD_DATE is selected, the type of the RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000792 has to be selected, too. Define exactly one of the
793 following options:
794
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000795 CONFIG_RTC_PCF8563 - use Philips PCF8563 RTC
Fabio Estevam3f8d1782011-10-24 06:44:15 +0000796 CONFIG_RTC_MC13XXX - use MC13783 or MC13892 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000797 CONFIG_RTC_MC146818 - use MC146818 RTC
wdenk1fe2c702003-03-06 21:55:29 +0000798 CONFIG_RTC_DS1307 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1307 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000799 CONFIG_RTC_DS1337 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1337 RTC
wdenk0893c472003-05-20 14:25:27 +0000800 CONFIG_RTC_DS1338 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1338 RTC
Markus Niebel90491f22014-07-21 11:06:16 +0200801 CONFIG_RTC_DS1339 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1339 RTC
wdenkef5fe752003-03-12 10:41:04 +0000802 CONFIG_RTC_DS164x - use Dallas DS164x RTC
Tor Krillb27939b2008-03-15 15:40:26 +0100803 CONFIG_RTC_ISL1208 - use Intersil ISL1208 RTC
wdenkaeba06f2004-06-09 17:34:58 +0000804 CONFIG_RTC_MAX6900 - use Maxim, Inc. MAX6900 RTC
Chris Packham2d3ac512017-05-30 12:03:33 +1200805 CONFIG_RTC_DS1337_NOOSC - Turn off the OSC output for DS1337
Heiko Schocher1f1b7012011-03-28 09:24:22 +0200806 CONFIG_SYS_RV3029_TCR - enable trickle charger on
807 RV3029 RTC.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000808
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +0000809 Note that if the RTC uses I2C, then the I2C interface
810 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
811
Peter Tyser9902e422008-12-17 16:36:21 -0600812- GPIO Support:
813 CONFIG_PCA953X - use NXP's PCA953X series I2C GPIO
Peter Tyser9902e422008-12-17 16:36:21 -0600814
Chris Packham9b383202010-12-19 10:12:13 +0000815 The CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PCA953X_WIDTH option specifies a list of
816 chip-ngpio pairs that tell the PCA953X driver the number of
817 pins supported by a particular chip.
818
Peter Tyser9902e422008-12-17 16:36:21 -0600819 Note that if the GPIO device uses I2C, then the I2C interface
820 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
821
Simon Glass4dc47ca2014-06-11 23:29:41 -0600822- I/O tracing:
823 When CONFIG_IO_TRACE is selected, U-Boot intercepts all I/O
824 accesses and can checksum them or write a list of them out
825 to memory. See the 'iotrace' command for details. This is
826 useful for testing device drivers since it can confirm that
827 the driver behaves the same way before and after a code
828 change. Currently this is supported on sandbox and arm. To
829 add support for your architecture, add '#include <iotrace.h>'
830 to the bottom of arch/<arch>/include/asm/io.h and test.
831
832 Example output from the 'iotrace stats' command is below.
833 Note that if the trace buffer is exhausted, the checksum will
834 still continue to operate.
835
836 iotrace is enabled
837 Start: 10000000 (buffer start address)
838 Size: 00010000 (buffer size)
839 Offset: 00000120 (current buffer offset)
840 Output: 10000120 (start + offset)
841 Count: 00000018 (number of trace records)
842 CRC32: 9526fb66 (CRC32 of all trace records)
843
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000844- Timestamp Support:
845
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000846 When CONFIG_TIMESTAMP is selected, the timestamp
847 (date and time) of an image is printed by image
848 commands like bootm or iminfo. This option is
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500849 automatically enabled when you select CONFIG_CMD_DATE .
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000850
Karl O. Pinc8b1f90a2012-08-16 06:20:15 +0000851- Partition Labels (disklabels) Supported:
852 Zero or more of the following:
853 CONFIG_MAC_PARTITION Apple's MacOS partition table.
Karl O. Pinc8b1f90a2012-08-16 06:20:15 +0000854 CONFIG_ISO_PARTITION ISO partition table, used on CDROM etc.
855 CONFIG_EFI_PARTITION GPT partition table, common when EFI is the
856 bootloader. Note 2TB partition limit; see
857 disk/part_efi.c
Simon Glass8706b812016-05-01 11:36:02 -0600858 CONFIG_SCSI) you must configure support for at
Karl O. Pinc8b1f90a2012-08-16 06:20:15 +0000859 least one non-MTD partition type as well.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000860
861- IDE Reset method:
wdenk369d43d2004-03-14 14:09:05 +0000862 CONFIG_IDE_RESET_ROUTINE - this is defined in several
863 board configurations files but used nowhere!
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000864
wdenk369d43d2004-03-14 14:09:05 +0000865 CONFIG_IDE_RESET - is this is defined, IDE Reset will
866 be performed by calling the function
867 ide_set_reset(int reset)
868 which has to be defined in a board specific file
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000869
870- ATAPI Support:
871 CONFIG_ATAPI
872
873 Set this to enable ATAPI support.
874
wdenkf602aa02004-03-13 23:29:43 +0000875- LBA48 Support
876 CONFIG_LBA48
877
878 Set this to enable support for disks larger than 137GB
Heiko Schocher0f602e12009-12-03 11:21:21 +0100879 Also look at CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA.
wdenkf602aa02004-03-13 23:29:43 +0000880 Whithout these , LBA48 support uses 32bit variables and will 'only'
881 support disks up to 2.1TB.
882
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200883 CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA:
wdenkf602aa02004-03-13 23:29:43 +0000884 When enabled, makes the IDE subsystem use 64bit sector addresses.
885 Default is 32bit.
886
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000887- SCSI Support:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200888 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN [8], CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID [7] and
889 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_DEVICE [CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID *
890 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN] can be adjusted to define the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000891 maximum numbers of LUNs, SCSI ID's and target
892 devices.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000893
Wolfgang Denkec7fbf52013-10-04 17:43:24 +0200894 The environment variable 'scsidevs' is set to the number of
895 SCSI devices found during the last scan.
Stefan Reinauere50a10e2012-10-29 05:23:48 +0000896
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000897- NETWORK Support (PCI):
wdenk4e112c12003-06-03 23:54:09 +0000898 CONFIG_E1000
Kyle Moffett64b94dd2011-10-18 11:05:29 +0000899 Support for Intel 8254x/8257x gigabit chips.
900
901 CONFIG_E1000_SPI
902 Utility code for direct access to the SPI bus on Intel 8257x.
903 This does not do anything useful unless you set at least one
904 of CONFIG_CMD_E1000 or CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC.
905
906 CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC
907 Allow generic access to the SPI bus on the Intel 8257x, for
908 example with the "sspi" command.
909
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000910 CONFIG_EEPRO100
911 Support for Intel 82557/82559/82559ER chips.
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200912 Optional CONFIG_EEPRO100_SROM_WRITE enables EEPROM
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000913 write routine for first time initialisation.
914
915 CONFIG_TULIP
916 Support for Digital 2114x chips.
917 Optional CONFIG_TULIP_SELECT_MEDIA for board specific
918 modem chip initialisation (KS8761/QS6611).
919
920 CONFIG_NATSEMI
921 Support for National dp83815 chips.
922
923 CONFIG_NS8382X
924 Support for National dp8382[01] gigabit chips.
925
wdenkaa603362003-05-12 21:50:16 +0000926- NETWORK Support (other):
927
Jens Scharsigdab7cb82010-01-23 12:03:45 +0100928 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC
929 Support for AT91RM9200 EMAC.
930
931 CONFIG_RMII
932 Define this to use reduced MII inteface
933
934 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC_QUIET
935 If this defined, the driver is quiet.
936 The driver doen't show link status messages.
937
Rob Herringc9830dc2011-12-15 11:15:49 +0000938 CONFIG_CALXEDA_XGMAC
939 Support for the Calxeda XGMAC device
940
Ashok93fb8722012-10-15 06:20:47 +0000941 CONFIG_LAN91C96
wdenkaa603362003-05-12 21:50:16 +0000942 Support for SMSC's LAN91C96 chips.
943
wdenkaa603362003-05-12 21:50:16 +0000944 CONFIG_LAN91C96_USE_32_BIT
945 Define this to enable 32 bit addressing
946
Ashok93fb8722012-10-15 06:20:47 +0000947 CONFIG_SMC91111
wdenk3c711762004-06-09 13:37:52 +0000948 Support for SMSC's LAN91C111 chip
949
950 CONFIG_SMC91111_BASE
951 Define this to hold the physical address
952 of the device (I/O space)
953
954 CONFIG_SMC_USE_32_BIT
955 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
956
957 CONFIG_SMC_USE_IOFUNCS
958 Define this to use i/o functions instead of macros
959 (some hardware wont work with macros)
960
Heiko Schocher7d037f72011-11-15 10:00:04 -0500961 CONFIG_SYS_DAVINCI_EMAC_PHY_COUNT
962 Define this if you have more then 3 PHYs.
963
Macpaul Lin199c6252010-12-21 16:59:46 +0800964 CONFIG_FTGMAC100
965 Support for Faraday's FTGMAC100 Gigabit SoC Ethernet
966
967 CONFIG_FTGMAC100_EGIGA
968 Define this to use GE link update with gigabit PHY.
969 Define this if FTGMAC100 is connected to gigabit PHY.
970 If your system has 10/100 PHY only, it might not occur
971 wrong behavior. Because PHY usually return timeout or
972 useless data when polling gigabit status and gigabit
973 control registers. This behavior won't affect the
974 correctnessof 10/100 link speed update.
975
Yoshihiro Shimodaed4cea02011-01-27 10:06:03 +0900976 CONFIG_SH_ETHER
977 Support for Renesas on-chip Ethernet controller
978
979 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_USE_PORT
980 Define the number of ports to be used
981
982 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_PHY_ADDR
983 Define the ETH PHY's address
984
Yoshihiro Shimoda281aa052011-01-27 10:06:08 +0900985 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_CACHE_WRITEBACK
986 If this option is set, the driver enables cache flush.
987
Heiko Schocher2b387762014-07-18 06:07:19 +0200988- PWM Support:
989 CONFIG_PWM_IMX
Robert P. J. Day1f8378a2016-09-13 08:35:18 -0400990 Support for PWM module on the imx6.
Heiko Schocher2b387762014-07-18 06:07:19 +0200991
Vadim Bendeburydac69642011-10-17 08:36:14 +0000992- TPM Support:
Che-liang Chiouacea5702013-04-12 11:04:34 +0000993 CONFIG_TPM
994 Support TPM devices.
995
Christophe Ricard8759ff82015-10-06 22:54:41 +0200996 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_INFINEON
997 Support for Infineon i2c bus TPM devices. Only one device
Tom Wai-Hong Tame49fed52013-04-12 11:04:37 +0000998 per system is supported at this time.
999
Tom Wai-Hong Tame49fed52013-04-12 11:04:37 +00001000 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_I2C_BURST_LIMITATION
1001 Define the burst count bytes upper limit
1002
Christophe Ricard88249232016-01-21 23:27:13 +01001003 CONFIG_TPM_ST33ZP24
1004 Support for STMicroelectronics TPM devices. Requires DM_TPM support.
1005
1006 CONFIG_TPM_ST33ZP24_I2C
1007 Support for STMicroelectronics ST33ZP24 I2C devices.
1008 Requires TPM_ST33ZP24 and I2C.
1009
Christophe Ricard5ffadc32016-01-21 23:27:14 +01001010 CONFIG_TPM_ST33ZP24_SPI
1011 Support for STMicroelectronics ST33ZP24 SPI devices.
1012 Requires TPM_ST33ZP24 and SPI.
1013
Dirk Eibach20489092013-06-26 15:55:15 +02001014 CONFIG_TPM_ATMEL_TWI
1015 Support for Atmel TWI TPM device. Requires I2C support.
1016
Che-liang Chiouacea5702013-04-12 11:04:34 +00001017 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_LPC
Vadim Bendeburydac69642011-10-17 08:36:14 +00001018 Support for generic parallel port TPM devices. Only one device
1019 per system is supported at this time.
1020
1021 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_BASE_ADDRESS
1022 Base address where the generic TPM device is mapped
1023 to. Contemporary x86 systems usually map it at
1024 0xfed40000.
1025
Reinhard Pfau4fece432013-06-26 15:55:13 +02001026 CONFIG_TPM
1027 Define this to enable the TPM support library which provides
1028 functional interfaces to some TPM commands.
1029 Requires support for a TPM device.
1030
1031 CONFIG_TPM_AUTH_SESSIONS
1032 Define this to enable authorized functions in the TPM library.
1033 Requires CONFIG_TPM and CONFIG_SHA1.
1034
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001035- USB Support:
1036 At the moment only the UHCI host controller is
Heiko Schocher6f90e582017-06-14 05:49:40 +02001037 supported (PIP405, MIP405); define
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001038 CONFIG_USB_UHCI to enable it.
1039 define CONFIG_USB_KEYBOARD to enable the USB Keyboard
wdenkfb30b4c2004-10-09 22:44:59 +00001040 and define CONFIG_USB_STORAGE to enable the USB
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001041 storage devices.
1042 Note:
1043 Supported are USB Keyboards and USB Floppy drives
1044 (TEAC FD-05PUB).
wdenk369d43d2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001045
Simon Glass5978cdb2012-02-27 10:52:47 +00001046 CONFIG_USB_EHCI_TXFIFO_THRESH enables setting of the
1047 txfilltuning field in the EHCI controller on reset.
1048
Oleksandr Tymoshenko7a881752014-02-01 21:51:25 -07001049 CONFIG_USB_DWC2_REG_ADDR the physical CPU address of the DWC2
1050 HW module registers.
1051
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001052- USB Device:
1053 Define the below if you wish to use the USB console.
1054 Once firmware is rebuilt from a serial console issue the
1055 command "setenv stdin usbtty; setenv stdout usbtty" and
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001056 attach your USB cable. The Unix command "dmesg" should print
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001057 it has found a new device. The environment variable usbtty
1058 can be set to gserial or cdc_acm to enable your device to
Wolfgang Denke2601822006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001059 appear to a USB host as a Linux gserial device or a
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001060 Common Device Class Abstract Control Model serial device.
1061 If you select usbtty = gserial you should be able to enumerate
1062 a Linux host by
1063 # modprobe usbserial vendor=0xVendorID product=0xProductID
1064 else if using cdc_acm, simply setting the environment
1065 variable usbtty to be cdc_acm should suffice. The following
1066 might be defined in YourBoardName.h
Wolfgang Denke2601822006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001067
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001068 CONFIG_USB_DEVICE
1069 Define this to build a UDC device
1070
1071 CONFIG_USB_TTY
1072 Define this to have a tty type of device available to
1073 talk to the UDC device
Wolfgang Denke2601822006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001074
Vipin KUMARbdb17702012-03-26 15:38:06 +05301075 CONFIG_USBD_HS
1076 Define this to enable the high speed support for usb
1077 device and usbtty. If this feature is enabled, a routine
1078 int is_usbd_high_speed(void)
1079 also needs to be defined by the driver to dynamically poll
1080 whether the enumeration has succeded at high speed or full
1081 speed.
1082
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001083 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001084 Define this if you want stdin, stdout &/or stderr to
1085 be set to usbtty.
1086
Wolfgang Denke2601822006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001087 If you have a USB-IF assigned VendorID then you may wish to
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001088 define your own vendor specific values either in BoardName.h
Wolfgang Denke2601822006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001089 or directly in usbd_vendor_info.h. If you don't define
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001090 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER, CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME,
1091 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID and CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID, then U-Boot
1092 should pretend to be a Linux device to it's target host.
1093
1094 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER
1095 Define this string as the name of your company for
1096 - CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER "my company"
Wolfgang Denke2601822006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001097
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001098 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME
1099 Define this string as the name of your product
1100 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME "acme usb device"
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001101
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001102 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID
1103 Define this as your assigned Vendor ID from the USB
1104 Implementors Forum. This *must* be a genuine Vendor ID
1105 to avoid polluting the USB namespace.
1106 - CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID 0xFFFF
Wolfgang Denke2601822006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001107
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001108 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID
1109 Define this as the unique Product ID
1110 for your device
1111 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID 0xFFFF
Wolfgang Denke2601822006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001112
Igor Grinbergac5f6ee2011-12-12 12:08:35 +02001113- ULPI Layer Support:
1114 The ULPI (UTMI Low Pin (count) Interface) PHYs are supported via
1115 the generic ULPI layer. The generic layer accesses the ULPI PHY
1116 via the platform viewport, so you need both the genric layer and
1117 the viewport enabled. Currently only Chipidea/ARC based
1118 viewport is supported.
1119 To enable the ULPI layer support, define CONFIG_USB_ULPI and
1120 CONFIG_USB_ULPI_VIEWPORT in your board configuration file.
Lucas Stachf31e4112012-10-01 00:44:35 +02001121 If your ULPI phy needs a different reference clock than the
1122 standard 24 MHz then you have to define CONFIG_ULPI_REF_CLK to
1123 the appropriate value in Hz.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001124
wdenk7a428cc2003-06-15 22:40:42 +00001125- MMC Support:
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001126 The MMC controller on the Intel PXA is supported. To
1127 enable this define CONFIG_MMC. The MMC can be
1128 accessed from the boot prompt by mapping the device
wdenk7a428cc2003-06-15 22:40:42 +00001129 to physical memory similar to flash. Command line is
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001130 enabled with CONFIG_CMD_MMC. The MMC driver also works with
1131 the FAT fs. This is enabled with CONFIG_CMD_FAT.
wdenk7a428cc2003-06-15 22:40:42 +00001132
Yoshihiro Shimodadb7717b2011-07-04 22:21:22 +00001133 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF
1134 Support for Renesas on-chip MMCIF controller
1135
1136 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_ADDR
1137 Define the base address of MMCIF registers
1138
1139 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_CLK
1140 Define the clock frequency for MMCIF
1141
Pierre Aubertbcc302c2014-04-24 10:30:08 +02001142 CONFIG_SUPPORT_EMMC_BOOT
1143 Enable some additional features of the eMMC boot partitions.
1144
Tom Rini58a8d322013-03-14 05:32:47 +00001145- USB Device Firmware Update (DFU) class support:
Marek Vasut7f8d4362018-02-16 16:41:18 +01001146 CONFIG_DFU_OVER_USB
Tom Rini58a8d322013-03-14 05:32:47 +00001147 This enables the USB portion of the DFU USB class
1148
Pantelis Antonioucf14d0d2013-03-14 05:32:52 +00001149 CONFIG_DFU_NAND
1150 This enables support for exposing NAND devices via DFU.
1151
Afzal Mohammede3c687a2013-09-18 01:15:24 +05301152 CONFIG_DFU_RAM
1153 This enables support for exposing RAM via DFU.
1154 Note: DFU spec refer to non-volatile memory usage, but
1155 allow usages beyond the scope of spec - here RAM usage,
1156 one that would help mostly the developer.
1157
Heiko Schochera2f831e2013-06-12 06:05:51 +02001158 CONFIG_SYS_DFU_DATA_BUF_SIZE
1159 Dfu transfer uses a buffer before writing data to the
1160 raw storage device. Make the size (in bytes) of this buffer
1161 configurable. The size of this buffer is also configurable
1162 through the "dfu_bufsiz" environment variable.
1163
Pantelis Antonioua6e788d2013-03-14 05:32:48 +00001164 CONFIG_SYS_DFU_MAX_FILE_SIZE
1165 When updating files rather than the raw storage device,
1166 we use a static buffer to copy the file into and then write
1167 the buffer once we've been given the whole file. Define
1168 this to the maximum filesize (in bytes) for the buffer.
1169 Default is 4 MiB if undefined.
1170
Heiko Schochere1ba1512014-03-18 08:09:56 +01001171 DFU_DEFAULT_POLL_TIMEOUT
1172 Poll timeout [ms], is the timeout a device can send to the
1173 host. The host must wait for this timeout before sending
1174 a subsequent DFU_GET_STATUS request to the device.
1175
1176 DFU_MANIFEST_POLL_TIMEOUT
1177 Poll timeout [ms], which the device sends to the host when
1178 entering dfuMANIFEST state. Host waits this timeout, before
1179 sending again an USB request to the device.
1180
wdenkda04a8b2004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001181- Journaling Flash filesystem support:
Simon Glassfa8527b2016-10-02 18:00:59 -06001182 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND
wdenkda04a8b2004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001183 Define these for a default partition on a NAND device
1184
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001185 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_SECTOR,
1186 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_BANK, CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_NUM_BANKS
wdenkda04a8b2004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001187 Define these for a default partition on a NOR device
1188
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001189- Keyboard Support:
Simon Glasseaba37e2015-11-11 10:05:47 -07001190 See Kconfig help for available keyboard drivers.
1191
1192 CONFIG_KEYBOARD
1193
1194 Define this to enable a custom keyboard support.
1195 This simply calls drv_keyboard_init() which must be
1196 defined in your board-specific files. This option is deprecated
1197 and is only used by novena. For new boards, use driver model
1198 instead.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001199
1200- Video support:
Timur Tabi020edd22011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001201 CONFIG_FSL_DIU_FB
Wolfgang Denk825223d2011-09-11 21:24:09 +02001202 Enable the Freescale DIU video driver. Reference boards for
Timur Tabi020edd22011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001203 SOCs that have a DIU should define this macro to enable DIU
1204 support, and should also define these other macros:
1205
1206 CONFIG_SYS_DIU_ADDR
1207 CONFIG_VIDEO
Timur Tabi020edd22011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001208 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
1209 CONFIG_VIDEO_SW_CURSOR
1210 CONFIG_VGA_AS_SINGLE_DEVICE
1211 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
1212 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO
1213
Timur Tabi32f709e2011-04-11 14:18:22 -05001214 The DIU driver will look for the 'video-mode' environment
1215 variable, and if defined, enable the DIU as a console during
Fabio Estevamd3ad5e52016-04-02 11:53:18 -03001216 boot. See the documentation file doc/README.video for a
Timur Tabi32f709e2011-04-11 14:18:22 -05001217 description of this variable.
Timur Tabi020edd22011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001218
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001219- LCD Support: CONFIG_LCD
1220
1221 Define this to enable LCD support (for output to LCD
1222 display); also select one of the supported displays
1223 by defining one of these:
1224
Stelian Popf6f86652008-05-09 21:57:18 +02001225 CONFIG_ATMEL_LCD:
1226
1227 HITACHI TX09D70VM1CCA, 3.5", 240x320.
1228
wdenkc0d54ae2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001229 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448AC33:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001230
wdenkc0d54ae2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001231 NEC NL6448AC33-18. Active, color, single scan.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001232
wdenkc0d54ae2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001233 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC20
1234
1235 NEC NL6448BC20-08. 6.5", 640x480.
1236 Active, color, single scan.
1237
1238 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC33_54
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001239
wdenkc0d54ae2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001240 NEC NL6448BC33-54. 10.4", 640x480.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001241 Active, color, single scan.
1242
1243 CONFIG_SHARP_16x9
1244
1245 Sharp 320x240. Active, color, single scan.
1246 It isn't 16x9, and I am not sure what it is.
1247
1248 CONFIG_SHARP_LQ64D341
1249
1250 Sharp LQ64D341 display, 640x480.
1251 Active, color, single scan.
1252
1253 CONFIG_HLD1045
1254
1255 HLD1045 display, 640x480.
1256 Active, color, single scan.
1257
1258 CONFIG_OPTREX_BW
1259
1260 Optrex CBL50840-2 NF-FW 99 22 M5
1261 or
1262 Hitachi LMG6912RPFC-00T
1263 or
1264 Hitachi SP14Q002
1265
1266 320x240. Black & white.
1267
Simon Glass599a4df2012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001268 CONFIG_LCD_ALIGNMENT
1269
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08001270 Normally the LCD is page-aligned (typically 4KB). If this is
Simon Glass599a4df2012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001271 defined then the LCD will be aligned to this value instead.
1272 For ARM it is sometimes useful to use MMU_SECTION_SIZE
1273 here, since it is cheaper to change data cache settings on
1274 a per-section basis.
1275
1276
Hannes Petermaiera3c8e862015-03-27 08:01:38 +01001277 CONFIG_LCD_ROTATION
1278
1279 Sometimes, for example if the display is mounted in portrait
1280 mode or even if it's mounted landscape but rotated by 180degree,
1281 we need to rotate our content of the display relative to the
1282 framebuffer, so that user can read the messages which are
1283 printed out.
1284 Once CONFIG_LCD_ROTATION is defined, the lcd_console will be
1285 initialized with a given rotation from "vl_rot" out of
1286 "vidinfo_t" which is provided by the board specific code.
1287 The value for vl_rot is coded as following (matching to
1288 fbcon=rotate:<n> linux-kernel commandline):
1289 0 = no rotation respectively 0 degree
1290 1 = 90 degree rotation
1291 2 = 180 degree rotation
1292 3 = 270 degree rotation
1293
1294 If CONFIG_LCD_ROTATION is not defined, the console will be
1295 initialized with 0degree rotation.
1296
Tom Wai-Hong Tam79926a42012-09-28 15:11:16 +00001297 CONFIG_LCD_BMP_RLE8
1298
1299 Support drawing of RLE8-compressed bitmaps on the LCD.
1300
Tom Wai-Hong Tam6664f202012-12-05 14:46:40 +00001301 CONFIG_I2C_EDID
1302
1303 Enables an 'i2c edid' command which can read EDID
1304 information over I2C from an attached LCD display.
1305
wdenkeb20ad32003-09-05 23:19:14 +00001306- Splash Screen Support: CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN
wdenk92bbe3f2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001307
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001308 If this option is set, the environment is checked for
1309 a variable "splashimage". If found, the usual display
1310 of logo, copyright and system information on the LCD
wdenk01686632004-06-30 22:59:18 +00001311 is suppressed and the BMP image at the address
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001312 specified in "splashimage" is loaded instead. The
1313 console is redirected to the "nulldev", too. This
1314 allows for a "silent" boot where a splash screen is
1315 loaded very quickly after power-on.
wdenk92bbe3f2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001316
Nikita Kiryanov2f3e2ca2013-02-24 21:28:43 +00001317 CONFIG_SPLASHIMAGE_GUARD
1318
1319 If this option is set, then U-Boot will prevent the environment
1320 variable "splashimage" from being set to a problematic address
Fabio Estevama58b4912016-03-23 12:46:12 -03001321 (see doc/README.displaying-bmps).
Nikita Kiryanov2f3e2ca2013-02-24 21:28:43 +00001322 This option is useful for targets where, due to alignment
1323 restrictions, an improperly aligned BMP image will cause a data
1324 abort. If you think you will not have problems with unaligned
1325 accesses (for example because your toolchain prevents them)
1326 there is no need to set this option.
1327
Matthias Weisser53884182009-07-09 16:07:30 +02001328 CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN_ALIGN
1329
1330 If this option is set the splash image can be freely positioned
1331 on the screen. Environment variable "splashpos" specifies the
1332 position as "x,y". If a positive number is given it is used as
1333 number of pixel from left/top. If a negative number is given it
1334 is used as number of pixel from right/bottom. You can also
1335 specify 'm' for centering the image.
1336
1337 Example:
1338 setenv splashpos m,m
1339 => image at center of screen
1340
1341 setenv splashpos 30,20
1342 => image at x = 30 and y = 20
1343
1344 setenv splashpos -10,m
1345 => vertically centered image
1346 at x = dspWidth - bmpWidth - 9
1347
Stefan Roesed9d97742005-09-22 09:04:17 +02001348- Gzip compressed BMP image support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_GZIP
1349
1350 If this option is set, additionally to standard BMP
1351 images, gzipped BMP images can be displayed via the
1352 splashscreen support or the bmp command.
1353
Anatolij Gustschin6b4e4fc2010-03-15 14:50:25 +01001354- Run length encoded BMP image (RLE8) support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_RLE8
1355
1356 If this option is set, 8-bit RLE compressed BMP images
1357 can be displayed via the splashscreen support or the
1358 bmp command.
1359
wdenk710e3502003-08-29 20:57:53 +00001360- Compression support:
Kees Cook5b06e642013-08-16 07:59:12 -07001361 CONFIG_GZIP
1362
1363 Enabled by default to support gzip compressed images.
1364
wdenk710e3502003-08-29 20:57:53 +00001365 CONFIG_BZIP2
1366
1367 If this option is set, support for bzip2 compressed
1368 images is included. If not, only uncompressed and gzip
1369 compressed images are supported.
1370
wdenk9c53f402003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001371 NOTE: the bzip2 algorithm requires a lot of RAM, so
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001372 the malloc area (as defined by CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN) should
wdenk9c53f402003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001373 be at least 4MB.
wdenk92bbe3f2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001374
wdenk0e2bd9c2004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001375- MII/PHY support:
wdenk0e2bd9c2004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001376 CONFIG_PHY_CLOCK_FREQ (ppc4xx)
1377
1378 The clock frequency of the MII bus
1379
wdenk0e2bd9c2004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001380 CONFIG_PHY_RESET_DELAY
1381
1382 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1383 reset before any MII register access is possible.
1384 For such PHY, set this option to the usec delay
1385 required. (minimum 300usec for LXT971A)
1386
1387 CONFIG_PHY_CMD_DELAY (ppc4xx)
1388
1389 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1390 command issued before MII status register can be read
1391
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001392- IP address:
1393 CONFIG_IPADDR
1394
1395 Define a default value for the IP address to use for
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001396 the default Ethernet interface, in case this is not
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001397 determined through e.g. bootp.
Wolfgang Denk26da2992011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001398 (Environment variable "ipaddr")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001399
1400- Server IP address:
1401 CONFIG_SERVERIP
1402
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001403 Defines a default value for the IP address of a TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001404 server to contact when using the "tftboot" command.
Wolfgang Denk26da2992011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001405 (Environment variable "serverip")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001406
Robin Getz470a6d42009-07-21 12:15:28 -04001407 CONFIG_KEEP_SERVERADDR
1408
1409 Keeps the server's MAC address, in the env 'serveraddr'
1410 for passing to bootargs (like Linux's netconsole option)
1411
Wolfgang Denk26da2992011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001412- Gateway IP address:
1413 CONFIG_GATEWAYIP
1414
1415 Defines a default value for the IP address of the
1416 default router where packets to other networks are
1417 sent to.
1418 (Environment variable "gatewayip")
1419
1420- Subnet mask:
1421 CONFIG_NETMASK
1422
1423 Defines a default value for the subnet mask (or
1424 routing prefix) which is used to determine if an IP
1425 address belongs to the local subnet or needs to be
1426 forwarded through a router.
1427 (Environment variable "netmask")
1428
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001429- BOOTP Recovery Mode:
1430 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY
1431
1432 If you have many targets in a network that try to
1433 boot using BOOTP, you may want to avoid that all
1434 systems send out BOOTP requests at precisely the same
1435 moment (which would happen for instance at recovery
1436 from a power failure, when all systems will try to
1437 boot, thus flooding the BOOTP server. Defining
1438 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY causes a random delay to be
1439 inserted before sending out BOOTP requests. The
Wolfgang Denkb65aaf92007-08-06 23:21:05 +02001440 following delays are inserted then:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001441
1442 1st BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 1 sec
1443 2nd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 2 sec
1444 3rd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 4 sec
1445 4th and following
1446 BOOTP requests: delay 0 ... 8 sec
1447
Thierry Reding8977cda2014-08-19 10:21:24 +02001448 CONFIG_BOOTP_ID_CACHE_SIZE
1449
1450 BOOTP packets are uniquely identified using a 32-bit ID. The
1451 server will copy the ID from client requests to responses and
1452 U-Boot will use this to determine if it is the destination of
1453 an incoming response. Some servers will check that addresses
1454 aren't in use before handing them out (usually using an ARP
1455 ping) and therefore take up to a few hundred milliseconds to
1456 respond. Network congestion may also influence the time it
1457 takes for a response to make it back to the client. If that
1458 time is too long, U-Boot will retransmit requests. In order
1459 to allow earlier responses to still be accepted after these
1460 retransmissions, U-Boot's BOOTP client keeps a small cache of
1461 IDs. The CONFIG_BOOTP_ID_CACHE_SIZE controls the size of this
1462 cache. The default is to keep IDs for up to four outstanding
1463 requests. Increasing this will allow U-Boot to accept offers
1464 from a BOOTP client in networks with unusually high latency.
1465
stroesee0aadfb2003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001466- DHCP Advanced Options:
Jon Loeliger5336a762007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001467 You can fine tune the DHCP functionality by defining
1468 CONFIG_BOOTP_* symbols:
stroesee0aadfb2003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001469
Jon Loeliger5336a762007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001470 CONFIG_BOOTP_NISDOMAIN
Jon Loeliger5336a762007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001471 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTFILESIZE
Jon Loeliger5336a762007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001472 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME
1473 CONFIG_BOOTP_NTPSERVER
1474 CONFIG_BOOTP_TIMEOFFSET
1475 CONFIG_BOOTP_VENDOREX
Joe Hershberger8ca7fa02012-05-23 07:59:19 +00001476 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL
stroesee0aadfb2003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001477
Wilson Callan22bcd6e2007-07-28 10:56:13 -04001478 CONFIG_BOOTP_SERVERIP - TFTP server will be the serverip
1479 environment variable, not the BOOTP server.
stroesee0aadfb2003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001480
Joe Hershberger8ca7fa02012-05-23 07:59:19 +00001481 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL - If the DHCP server is not found
1482 after the configured retry count, the call will fail
1483 instead of starting over. This can be used to fail over
1484 to Link-local IP address configuration if the DHCP server
1485 is not available.
1486
stroesee0aadfb2003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001487 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME - Some DHCP servers are capable
1488 to do a dynamic update of a DNS server. To do this, they
1489 need the hostname of the DHCP requester.
Wilson Callan22bcd6e2007-07-28 10:56:13 -04001490 If CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME is defined, the content
Jon Loeliger5336a762007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001491 of the "hostname" environment variable is passed as
1492 option 12 to the DHCP server.
stroesee0aadfb2003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001493
Aras Vaichas72aa3f32008-03-26 09:43:57 +11001494 CONFIG_BOOTP_DHCP_REQUEST_DELAY
1495
1496 A 32bit value in microseconds for a delay between
1497 receiving a "DHCP Offer" and sending the "DHCP Request".
1498 This fixes a problem with certain DHCP servers that don't
1499 respond 100% of the time to a "DHCP request". E.g. On an
1500 AT91RM9200 processor running at 180MHz, this delay needed
1501 to be *at least* 15,000 usec before a Windows Server 2003
1502 DHCP server would reply 100% of the time. I recommend at
1503 least 50,000 usec to be safe. The alternative is to hope
1504 that one of the retries will be successful but note that
1505 the DHCP timeout and retry process takes a longer than
1506 this delay.
1507
Joe Hershbergerb35a3a62012-05-23 08:00:12 +00001508 - Link-local IP address negotiation:
1509 Negotiate with other link-local clients on the local network
1510 for an address that doesn't require explicit configuration.
1511 This is especially useful if a DHCP server cannot be guaranteed
1512 to exist in all environments that the device must operate.
1513
1514 See doc/README.link-local for more information.
1515
Prabhakar Kushwaha2dec06f2017-11-23 16:51:32 +05301516 - MAC address from environment variables
1517
1518 FDT_SEQ_MACADDR_FROM_ENV
1519
1520 Fix-up device tree with MAC addresses fetched sequentially from
1521 environment variables. This config work on assumption that
1522 non-usable ethernet node of device-tree are either not present
1523 or their status has been marked as "disabled".
1524
wdenk145d2c12004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001525 - CDP Options:
wdenk05939202004-04-18 17:39:38 +00001526 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID
wdenk145d2c12004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001527
1528 The device id used in CDP trigger frames.
1529
1530 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID_PREFIX
1531
1532 A two character string which is prefixed to the MAC address
1533 of the device.
1534
1535 CONFIG_CDP_PORT_ID
1536
1537 A printf format string which contains the ascii name of
1538 the port. Normally is set to "eth%d" which sets
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001539 eth0 for the first Ethernet, eth1 for the second etc.
wdenk145d2c12004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001540
1541 CONFIG_CDP_CAPABILITIES
1542
1543 A 32bit integer which indicates the device capabilities;
1544 0x00000010 for a normal host which does not forwards.
1545
1546 CONFIG_CDP_VERSION
1547
1548 An ascii string containing the version of the software.
1549
1550 CONFIG_CDP_PLATFORM
1551
1552 An ascii string containing the name of the platform.
1553
1554 CONFIG_CDP_TRIGGER
1555
1556 A 32bit integer sent on the trigger.
1557
1558 CONFIG_CDP_POWER_CONSUMPTION
1559
1560 A 16bit integer containing the power consumption of the
1561 device in .1 of milliwatts.
1562
1563 CONFIG_CDP_APPLIANCE_VLAN_TYPE
1564
1565 A byte containing the id of the VLAN.
1566
Uri Mashiach3dc6f652017-01-19 10:51:05 +02001567- Status LED: CONFIG_LED_STATUS
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001568
1569 Several configurations allow to display the current
1570 status using a LED. For instance, the LED will blink
1571 fast while running U-Boot code, stop blinking as
1572 soon as a reply to a BOOTP request was received, and
1573 start blinking slow once the Linux kernel is running
1574 (supported by a status LED driver in the Linux
Uri Mashiach3dc6f652017-01-19 10:51:05 +02001575 kernel). Defining CONFIG_LED_STATUS enables this
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001576 feature in U-Boot.
1577
Igor Grinberg4997a9e2013-11-08 01:03:50 +02001578 Additional options:
1579
Uri Mashiach3dc6f652017-01-19 10:51:05 +02001580 CONFIG_LED_STATUS_GPIO
Igor Grinberg4997a9e2013-11-08 01:03:50 +02001581 The status LED can be connected to a GPIO pin.
1582 In such cases, the gpio_led driver can be used as a
Uri Mashiach3dc6f652017-01-19 10:51:05 +02001583 status LED backend implementation. Define CONFIG_LED_STATUS_GPIO
Igor Grinberg4997a9e2013-11-08 01:03:50 +02001584 to include the gpio_led driver in the U-Boot binary.
1585
Igor Grinberg203bd9f2013-11-08 01:03:52 +02001586 CONFIG_GPIO_LED_INVERTED_TABLE
1587 Some GPIO connected LEDs may have inverted polarity in which
1588 case the GPIO high value corresponds to LED off state and
1589 GPIO low value corresponds to LED on state.
1590 In such cases CONFIG_GPIO_LED_INVERTED_TABLE may be defined
1591 with a list of GPIO LEDs that have inverted polarity.
1592
Heiko Schochere0e55bc2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00001593- I2C Support: CONFIG_SYS_I2C
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001594
Heiko Schochere0e55bc2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00001595 This enable the NEW i2c subsystem, and will allow you to use
1596 i2c commands at the u-boot command line (as long as you set
1597 CONFIG_CMD_I2C in CONFIG_COMMANDS) and communicate with i2c
1598 based realtime clock chips or other i2c devices. See
1599 common/cmd_i2c.c for a description of the command line
1600 interface.
1601
1602 ported i2c driver to the new framework:
Heiko Schocher479a4cf2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01001603 - drivers/i2c/soft_i2c.c:
1604 - activate first bus with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT define
1605 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE
1606 for defining speed and slave address
1607 - activate second bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS2 define
1608 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_2 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_2
1609 for defining speed and slave address
1610 - activate third bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS3 define
1611 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_3 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_3
1612 for defining speed and slave address
1613 - activate fourth bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS4 define
1614 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_4 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_4
1615 for defining speed and slave address
Heiko Schochere0e55bc2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00001616
Heiko Schocherf2850742012-10-24 13:48:22 +02001617 - drivers/i2c/fsl_i2c.c:
1618 - activate i2c driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_FSL
1619 define CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_OFFSET for setting the register
1620 offset CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_SPEED for the i2c speed and
1621 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_SLAVE for the slave addr of the first
1622 bus.
Wolfgang Denkec7fbf52013-10-04 17:43:24 +02001623 - If your board supports a second fsl i2c bus, define
Heiko Schocherf2850742012-10-24 13:48:22 +02001624 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_OFFSET for the register offset
1625 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_SPEED for the speed and
1626 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_SLAVE for the slave address of the
1627 second bus.
1628
Simon Glass026fefb2012-10-30 07:28:53 +00001629 - drivers/i2c/tegra_i2c.c:
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu045acfa2013-10-11 16:23:53 +09001630 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_TEGRA
1631 - This driver adds 4 i2c buses with a fix speed from
1632 100000 and the slave addr 0!
Simon Glass026fefb2012-10-30 07:28:53 +00001633
Dirk Eibach42b204f2013-04-25 02:40:01 +00001634 - drivers/i2c/ppc4xx_i2c.c
1635 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX
1636 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX_CH0 activate hardware channel 0
1637 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX_CH1 activate hardware channel 1
1638
trema49f40a2013-09-21 18:13:35 +02001639 - drivers/i2c/i2c_mxc.c
1640 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC
Albert ARIBAUD \\(3ADEV\\)eb943872015-09-21 22:43:38 +02001641 - enable bus 1 with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC_I2C1
1642 - enable bus 2 with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC_I2C2
1643 - enable bus 3 with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC_I2C3
1644 - enable bus 4 with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC_I2C4
trema49f40a2013-09-21 18:13:35 +02001645 - define speed for bus 1 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C1_SPEED
1646 - define slave for bus 1 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C1_SLAVE
1647 - define speed for bus 2 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C2_SPEED
1648 - define slave for bus 2 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C2_SLAVE
1649 - define speed for bus 3 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C3_SPEED
1650 - define slave for bus 3 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C3_SLAVE
Albert ARIBAUD \\(3ADEV\\)eb943872015-09-21 22:43:38 +02001651 - define speed for bus 4 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C4_SPEED
1652 - define slave for bus 4 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C4_SLAVE
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08001653 If those defines are not set, default value is 100000
trema49f40a2013-09-21 18:13:35 +02001654 for speed, and 0 for slave.
1655
Nobuhiro Iwamatsue94ea2f2013-09-27 16:58:30 +09001656 - drivers/i2c/rcar_i2c.c:
1657 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_RCAR
1658 - This driver adds 4 i2c buses
1659
1660 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C0_BASE for setting the register channel 0
1661 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C0_SPEED for for the speed channel 0
1662 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C1_BASE for setting the register channel 1
1663 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C1_SPEED for for the speed channel 1
1664 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C2_BASE for setting the register channel 2
1665 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C2_SPEED for for the speed channel 2
1666 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C3_BASE for setting the register channel 3
1667 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C3_SPEED for for the speed channel 3
1668 - CONFIF_SYS_RCAR_I2C_NUM_CONTROLLERS for number of i2c buses
1669
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu12240102013-10-29 13:33:51 +09001670 - drivers/i2c/sh_i2c.c:
1671 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH
1672 - This driver adds from 2 to 5 i2c buses
1673
1674 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE0 for setting the register channel 0
1675 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED0 for for the speed channel 0
1676 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE1 for setting the register channel 1
1677 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED1 for for the speed channel 1
1678 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE2 for setting the register channel 2
1679 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED2 for for the speed channel 2
1680 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE3 for setting the register channel 3
1681 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED3 for for the speed channel 3
1682 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE4 for setting the register channel 4
1683 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED4 for for the speed channel 4
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08001684 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_NUM_CONTROLLERS for number of i2c buses
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu12240102013-10-29 13:33:51 +09001685
Heiko Schocherf53f2b82013-10-22 11:03:18 +02001686 - drivers/i2c/omap24xx_i2c.c
1687 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_OMAP24XX
1688 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED speed channel 0
1689 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE slave addr channel 0
1690 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED1 speed channel 1
1691 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE1 slave addr channel 1
1692 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED2 speed channel 2
1693 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE2 slave addr channel 2
1694 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED3 speed channel 3
1695 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE3 slave addr channel 3
1696 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED4 speed channel 4
1697 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE4 slave addr channel 4
1698
Heiko Schocher465819a2013-11-08 07:30:53 +01001699 - drivers/i2c/zynq_i2c.c
1700 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ
1701 - set CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ_SPEED for speed setting
1702 - set CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ_SLAVE for slave addr
1703
Naveen Krishna Ch5d5efd32013-12-06 12:12:38 +05301704 - drivers/i2c/s3c24x0_i2c.c:
1705 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_S3C24X0
1706 - This driver adds i2c buses (11 for Exynos5250, Exynos5420
1707 9 i2c buses for Exynos4 and 1 for S3C24X0 SoCs from Samsung)
1708 with a fix speed from 100000 and the slave addr 0!
1709
Dirk Eibachb9577432014-07-03 09:28:18 +02001710 - drivers/i2c/ihs_i2c.c
1711 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS
1712 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH0 activate hardware channel 0
1713 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_0 speed channel 0
1714 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_0 slave addr channel 0
1715 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH1 activate hardware channel 1
1716 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_1 speed channel 1
1717 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_1 slave addr channel 1
1718 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH2 activate hardware channel 2
1719 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_2 speed channel 2
1720 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_2 slave addr channel 2
1721 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH3 activate hardware channel 3
1722 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_3 speed channel 3
1723 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_3 slave addr channel 3
Dirk Eibach9ac33852015-10-28 11:46:22 +01001724 - activate dual channel with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_DUAL
1725 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_0_1 speed channel 0_1
1726 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_0_1 slave addr channel 0_1
1727 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_1_1 speed channel 1_1
1728 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_1_1 slave addr channel 1_1
1729 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_2_1 speed channel 2_1
1730 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_2_1 slave addr channel 2_1
1731 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_3_1 speed channel 3_1
1732 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_3_1 slave addr channel 3_1
Dirk Eibachb9577432014-07-03 09:28:18 +02001733
Heiko Schochere0e55bc2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00001734 additional defines:
1735
1736 CONFIG_SYS_NUM_I2C_BUSES
Simon Glassb05e2b32016-10-02 18:01:05 -06001737 Hold the number of i2c buses you want to use.
Heiko Schochere0e55bc2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00001738
1739 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DIRECT_BUS
1740 define this, if you don't use i2c muxes on your hardware.
1741 if CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS is not defined or == 0 you can
1742 omit this define.
1743
1744 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS
1745 define how many muxes are maximal consecutively connected
1746 on one i2c bus. If you not use i2c muxes, omit this
1747 define.
1748
1749 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BUSES
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08001750 hold a list of buses you want to use, only used if
Heiko Schochere0e55bc2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00001751 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DIRECT_BUS is not defined, for example
1752 a board with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS = 1 and
1753 CONFIG_SYS_NUM_I2C_BUSES = 9:
1754
1755 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BUSES {{0, {I2C_NULL_HOP}}, \
1756 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 1}}}, \
1757 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 2}}}, \
1758 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 3}}}, \
1759 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 4}}}, \
1760 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 5}}}, \
1761 {1, {I2C_NULL_HOP}}, \
1762 {1, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9544, 0x72, 1}}}, \
1763 {1, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9544, 0x72, 2}}}, \
1764 }
1765
1766 which defines
1767 bus 0 on adapter 0 without a mux
Heiko Schocher479a4cf2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01001768 bus 1 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 1
1769 bus 2 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 2
1770 bus 3 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 3
1771 bus 4 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 4
1772 bus 5 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 5
Heiko Schochere0e55bc2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00001773 bus 6 on adapter 1 without a mux
Heiko Schocher479a4cf2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01001774 bus 7 on adapter 1 with a PCA9544 on address 0x72 port 1
1775 bus 8 on adapter 1 with a PCA9544 on address 0x72 port 2
Heiko Schochere0e55bc2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00001776
1777 If you do not have i2c muxes on your board, omit this define.
1778
Simon Glass3efce392017-05-12 21:10:00 -06001779- Legacy I2C Support:
Heiko Schocher479a4cf2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01001780 If you use the software i2c interface (CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT)
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001781 then the following macros need to be defined (examples are
1782 from include/configs/lwmon.h):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001783
1784 I2C_INIT
1785
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001786 (Optional). Any commands necessary to enable the I2C
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001787 controller or configure ports.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001788
wdenk544e9732004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001789 eg: #define I2C_INIT (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SCL)
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001790
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001791 I2C_ACTIVE
1792
1793 The code necessary to make the I2C data line active
1794 (driven). If the data line is open collector, this
1795 define can be null.
1796
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001797 eg: #define I2C_ACTIVE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SDA)
1798
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001799 I2C_TRISTATE
1800
1801 The code necessary to make the I2C data line tri-stated
1802 (inactive). If the data line is open collector, this
1803 define can be null.
1804
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001805 eg: #define I2C_TRISTATE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir &= ~PB_SDA)
1806
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001807 I2C_READ
1808
York Sun4a598092013-04-01 11:29:11 -07001809 Code that returns true if the I2C data line is high,
1810 false if it is low.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001811
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001812 eg: #define I2C_READ ((immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat & PB_SDA) != 0)
1813
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001814 I2C_SDA(bit)
1815
York Sun4a598092013-04-01 11:29:11 -07001816 If <bit> is true, sets the I2C data line high. If it
1817 is false, it clears it (low).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001818
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001819 eg: #define I2C_SDA(bit) \
wdenk2bb11052003-07-17 23:16:40 +00001820 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SDA; \
wdenk544e9732004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001821 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SDA
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001822
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001823 I2C_SCL(bit)
1824
York Sun4a598092013-04-01 11:29:11 -07001825 If <bit> is true, sets the I2C clock line high. If it
1826 is false, it clears it (low).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001827
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001828 eg: #define I2C_SCL(bit) \
wdenk2bb11052003-07-17 23:16:40 +00001829 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SCL; \
wdenk544e9732004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001830 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SCL
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001831
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001832 I2C_DELAY
1833
1834 This delay is invoked four times per clock cycle so this
1835 controls the rate of data transfer. The data rate thus
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001836 is 1 / (I2C_DELAY * 4). Often defined to be something
wdenk21136db2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001837 like:
1838
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001839 #define I2C_DELAY udelay(2)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001840
Mike Frysingeree12d542010-07-21 13:38:02 -04001841 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SCL / CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SDA
1842
1843 If your arch supports the generic GPIO framework (asm/gpio.h),
1844 then you may alternatively define the two GPIOs that are to be
1845 used as SCL / SDA. Any of the previous I2C_xxx macros will
1846 have GPIO-based defaults assigned to them as appropriate.
1847
1848 You should define these to the GPIO value as given directly to
1849 the generic GPIO functions.
1850
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001851 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD
wdenkcc1e2562003-03-06 13:39:27 +00001852
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001853 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
1854 chips might think that the current transfer is still
1855 in progress. On some boards it is possible to access
1856 the i2c SCLK line directly, either by using the
1857 processor pin as a GPIO or by having a second pin
1858 connected to the bus. If this option is defined a
1859 custom i2c_init_board() routine in boards/xxx/board.c
1860 is run early in the boot sequence.
wdenkcc1e2562003-03-06 13:39:27 +00001861
Ben Warren45657152006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001862 CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
1863
1864 This option allows the use of multiple I2C buses, each of which
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00001865 must have a controller. At any point in time, only one bus is
1866 active. To switch to a different bus, use the 'i2c dev' command.
Ben Warren45657152006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001867 Note that bus numbering is zero-based.
1868
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001869 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES
Ben Warren45657152006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001870
1871 This option specifies a list of I2C devices that will be skipped
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00001872 when the 'i2c probe' command is issued. If CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Peter Tyser469cde42009-04-18 22:34:03 -05001873 is set, specify a list of bus-device pairs. Otherwise, specify
1874 a 1D array of device addresses
Ben Warren45657152006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001875
1876 e.g.
1877 #undef CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00001878 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES {0x50,0x68}
Ben Warren45657152006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001879
1880 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on a board with one I2C bus
1881
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00001882 #define CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Simon Glassb05e2b32016-10-02 18:01:05 -06001883 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES {{0,0x50},{0,0x68},{1,0x54}}
Ben Warren45657152006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001884
1885 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on bus 0 and address 0x54 on bus 1
1886
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001887 CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Timur Tabiab347542006-11-03 19:15:00 -06001888
1889 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for DDR SPD.
1890 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that SPD is on I2C bus 0.
1891
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001892 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese096cc9b2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01001893
1894 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the RTC.
1895 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that RTC is on I2C bus 0.
1896
Andrew Dyer58c41f92008-12-29 17:36:01 -06001897 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_READ_REPEATED_START
1898
1899 defining this will force the i2c_read() function in
1900 the soft_i2c driver to perform an I2C repeated start
1901 between writing the address pointer and reading the
1902 data. If this define is omitted the default behaviour
1903 of doing a stop-start sequence will be used. Most I2C
1904 devices can use either method, but some require one or
1905 the other.
Timur Tabiab347542006-11-03 19:15:00 -06001906
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001907- SPI Support: CONFIG_SPI
1908
1909 Enables SPI driver (so far only tested with
1910 SPI EEPROM, also an instance works with Crystal A/D and
1911 D/As on the SACSng board)
1912
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001913 CONFIG_SOFT_SPI
1914
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001915 Enables a software (bit-bang) SPI driver rather than
1916 using hardware support. This is a general purpose
1917 driver that only requires three general I/O port pins
1918 (two outputs, one input) to function. If this is
1919 defined, the board configuration must define several
1920 SPI configuration items (port pins to use, etc). For
1921 an example, see include/configs/sacsng.h.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001922
Heiko Schocherb77c8882014-07-14 10:22:11 +02001923 CONFIG_SYS_SPI_MXC_WAIT
1924 Timeout for waiting until spi transfer completed.
1925 default: (CONFIG_SYS_HZ/100) /* 10 ms */
1926
Matthias Fuchsa4400872007-12-27 17:12:34 +01001927- FPGA Support: CONFIG_FPGA
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001928
Matthias Fuchsa4400872007-12-27 17:12:34 +01001929 Enables FPGA subsystem.
1930
1931 CONFIG_FPGA_<vendor>
1932
1933 Enables support for specific chip vendors.
1934 (ALTERA, XILINX)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001935
Matthias Fuchsa4400872007-12-27 17:12:34 +01001936 CONFIG_FPGA_<family>
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001937
Matthias Fuchsa4400872007-12-27 17:12:34 +01001938 Enables support for FPGA family.
1939 (SPARTAN2, SPARTAN3, VIRTEX2, CYCLONE2, ACEX1K, ACEX)
1940
1941 CONFIG_FPGA_COUNT
1942
1943 Specify the number of FPGA devices to support.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001944
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001945 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_PROG_FEEDBACK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001946
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001947 Enable printing of hash marks during FPGA configuration.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001948
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001949 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001950
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001951 Enable checks on FPGA configuration interface busy
1952 status by the configuration function. This option
1953 will require a board or device specific function to
1954 be written.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001955
1956 CONFIG_FPGA_DELAY
1957
1958 If defined, a function that provides delays in the FPGA
1959 configuration driver.
1960
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001961 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_CTRLC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001962 Allow Control-C to interrupt FPGA configuration
1963
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001964 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_ERROR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001965
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001966 Check for configuration errors during FPGA bitfile
1967 loading. For example, abort during Virtex II
1968 configuration if the INIT_B line goes low (which
1969 indicated a CRC error).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001970
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001971 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_INIT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001972
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08001973 Maximum time to wait for the INIT_B line to de-assert
1974 after PROB_B has been de-asserted during a Virtex II
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001975 FPGA configuration sequence. The default time is 500
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001976 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001977
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001978 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001979
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08001980 Maximum time to wait for BUSY to de-assert during
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001981 Virtex II FPGA configuration. The default is 5 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001982
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001983 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_CONFIG
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001984
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001985 Time to wait after FPGA configuration. The default is
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001986 200 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001987
1988- Configuration Management:
Stefan Roese141ed202014-10-22 12:13:24 +02001989 CONFIG_BUILD_TARGET
1990
1991 Some SoCs need special image types (e.g. U-Boot binary
1992 with a special header) as build targets. By defining
1993 CONFIG_BUILD_TARGET in the SoC / board header, this
1994 special image will be automatically built upon calling
Simon Glassdc27def2016-07-27 20:33:08 -06001995 make / buildman.
Stefan Roese141ed202014-10-22 12:13:24 +02001996
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001997 CONFIG_IDENT_STRING
1998
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001999 If defined, this string will be added to the U-Boot
2000 version information (U_BOOT_VERSION)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002001
2002- Vendor Parameter Protection:
2003
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002004 U-Boot considers the values of the environment
2005 variables "serial#" (Board Serial Number) and
wdenkeb20ad32003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002006 "ethaddr" (Ethernet Address) to be parameters that
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002007 are set once by the board vendor / manufacturer, and
2008 protects these variables from casual modification by
2009 the user. Once set, these variables are read-only,
2010 and write or delete attempts are rejected. You can
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002011 change this behaviour:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002012
2013 If CONFIG_ENV_OVERWRITE is #defined in your config
2014 file, the write protection for vendor parameters is
wdenkcc1e2562003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002015 completely disabled. Anybody can change or delete
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002016 these parameters.
2017
Joe Hershberger76f353e2015-05-04 14:55:14 -05002018 Alternatively, if you define _both_ an ethaddr in the
2019 default env _and_ CONFIG_OVERWRITE_ETHADDR_ONCE, a default
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002020 Ethernet address is installed in the environment,
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002021 which can be changed exactly ONCE by the user. [The
2022 serial# is unaffected by this, i. e. it remains
2023 read-only.]
2024
Joe Hershberger71497d02012-12-11 22:16:31 -06002025 The same can be accomplished in a more flexible way
2026 for any variable by configuring the type of access
2027 to allow for those variables in the ".flags" variable
2028 or define CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC.
2029
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002030- Protected RAM:
2031 CONFIG_PRAM
2032
2033 Define this variable to enable the reservation of
2034 "protected RAM", i. e. RAM which is not overwritten
2035 by U-Boot. Define CONFIG_PRAM to hold the number of
2036 kB you want to reserve for pRAM. You can overwrite
2037 this default value by defining an environment
2038 variable "pram" to the number of kB you want to
2039 reserve. Note that the board info structure will
2040 still show the full amount of RAM. If pRAM is
2041 reserved, a new environment variable "mem" will
2042 automatically be defined to hold the amount of
2043 remaining RAM in a form that can be passed as boot
2044 argument to Linux, for instance like that:
2045
Wolfgang Denk86eb3b72005-11-20 21:40:11 +01002046 setenv bootargs ... mem=\${mem}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002047 saveenv
2048
2049 This way you can tell Linux not to use this memory,
2050 either, which results in a memory region that will
2051 not be affected by reboots.
2052
2053 *WARNING* If your board configuration uses automatic
2054 detection of the RAM size, you must make sure that
2055 this memory test is non-destructive. So far, the
2056 following board configurations are known to be
2057 "pRAM-clean":
2058
Heiko Schocher65d94db2017-06-07 17:33:09 +02002059 IVMS8, IVML24, SPD8xx,
Wolfgang Denk90326762012-10-24 02:36:15 +00002060 HERMES, IP860, RPXlite, LWMON,
Heiko Schocher71cb3e92017-06-07 17:33:10 +02002061 FLAGADM
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002062
Gabe Blacka2f3a932012-12-02 04:55:18 +00002063- Access to physical memory region (> 4GB)
2064 Some basic support is provided for operations on memory not
2065 normally accessible to U-Boot - e.g. some architectures
2066 support access to more than 4GB of memory on 32-bit
2067 machines using physical address extension or similar.
2068 Define CONFIG_PHYSMEM to access this basic support, which
2069 currently only supports clearing the memory.
2070
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002071- Error Recovery:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002072 CONFIG_NET_RETRY_COUNT
2073
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002074 This variable defines the number of retries for
2075 network operations like ARP, RARP, TFTP, or BOOTP
2076 before giving up the operation. If not defined, a
2077 default value of 5 is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002078
Guennadi Liakhovetskib38c2b32008-04-03 17:04:19 +02002079 CONFIG_ARP_TIMEOUT
2080
2081 Timeout waiting for an ARP reply in milliseconds.
2082
Tetsuyuki Kobayashi147e3902012-07-03 22:25:21 +00002083 CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT
2084
2085 Timeout in milliseconds used in NFS protocol.
2086 If you encounter "ERROR: Cannot umount" in nfs command,
2087 try longer timeout such as
2088 #define CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT 10000UL
2089
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002090- Command Interpreter:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002091 CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT_HUSH_PS2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002092
2093 This defines the secondary prompt string, which is
2094 printed when the command interpreter needs more input
2095 to complete a command. Usually "> ".
2096
2097 Note:
2098
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002099 In the current implementation, the local variables
2100 space and global environment variables space are
2101 separated. Local variables are those you define by
2102 simply typing `name=value'. To access a local
2103 variable later on, you have write `$name' or
2104 `${name}'; to execute the contents of a variable
2105 directly type `$name' at the command prompt.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002106
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002107 Global environment variables are those you use
2108 setenv/printenv to work with. To run a command stored
2109 in such a variable, you need to use the run command,
2110 and you must not use the '$' sign to access them.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002111
2112 To store commands and special characters in a
2113 variable, please use double quotation marks
2114 surrounding the whole text of the variable, instead
2115 of the backslashes before semicolons and special
2116 symbols.
2117
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002118- Command Line Editing and History:
Marek Vasut734fb042016-01-27 04:47:55 +01002119 CONFIG_CMDLINE_PS_SUPPORT
2120
2121 Enable support for changing the command prompt string
2122 at run-time. Only static string is supported so far.
2123 The string is obtained from environment variables PS1
2124 and PS2.
2125
wdenkc0aa5c52003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002126- Default Environment:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002127 CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS
2128
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002129 Define this to contain any number of null terminated
2130 strings (variable = value pairs) that will be part of
wdenkeb20ad32003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002131 the default environment compiled into the boot image.
wdenk591dda52002-11-18 00:14:45 +00002132
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002133 For example, place something like this in your
2134 board's config file:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002135
2136 #define CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS \
2137 "myvar1=value1\0" \
2138 "myvar2=value2\0"
2139
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002140 Warning: This method is based on knowledge about the
2141 internal format how the environment is stored by the
2142 U-Boot code. This is NOT an official, exported
2143 interface! Although it is unlikely that this format
wdenkeb20ad32003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002144 will change soon, there is no guarantee either.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002145 You better know what you are doing here.
2146
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002147 Note: overly (ab)use of the default environment is
2148 discouraged. Make sure to check other ways to preset
Wolfgang Denk85c25df2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002149 the environment like the "source" command or the
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002150 boot command first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002151
Simon Glass6b8d5fd2012-11-30 13:01:17 +00002152 CONFIG_DELAY_ENVIRONMENT
2153
2154 Normally the environment is loaded when the board is
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002155 initialised so that it is available to U-Boot. This inhibits
Simon Glass6b8d5fd2012-11-30 13:01:17 +00002156 that so that the environment is not available until
2157 explicitly loaded later by U-Boot code. With CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
2158 this is instead controlled by the value of
2159 /config/load-environment.
2160
Eric Nelson97f5f8f2012-01-31 10:52:08 -07002161- Serial Flash support
Simon Glass663b0cc2017-08-04 16:35:06 -06002162 Usage requires an initial 'sf probe' to define the serial
Eric Nelson97f5f8f2012-01-31 10:52:08 -07002163 flash parameters, followed by read/write/erase/update
2164 commands.
2165
2166 The following defaults may be provided by the platform
2167 to handle the common case when only a single serial
2168 flash is present on the system.
2169
2170 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_BUS Bus identifier
2171 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_CS Chip-select
2172 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_MODE (see include/spi.h)
2173 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_SPEED in Hz
2174
wdenkef893942004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002175
Wolfgang Denke3cfce52005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002176- TFTP Fixed UDP Port:
2177 CONFIG_TFTP_PORT
2178
Wolfgang Denk227b5192005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002179 If this is defined, the environment variable tftpsrcp
Wolfgang Denke3cfce52005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002180 is used to supply the TFTP UDP source port value.
Wolfgang Denk227b5192005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002181 If tftpsrcp isn't defined, the normal pseudo-random port
Wolfgang Denke3cfce52005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002182 number generator is used.
2183
Wolfgang Denk227b5192005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002184 Also, the environment variable tftpdstp is used to supply
2185 the TFTP UDP destination port value. If tftpdstp isn't
2186 defined, the normal port 69 is used.
2187
2188 The purpose for tftpsrcp is to allow a TFTP server to
Wolfgang Denke3cfce52005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002189 blindly start the TFTP transfer using the pre-configured
2190 target IP address and UDP port. This has the effect of
2191 "punching through" the (Windows XP) firewall, allowing
2192 the remainder of the TFTP transfer to proceed normally.
2193 A better solution is to properly configure the firewall,
2194 but sometimes that is not allowed.
2195
wdenkc0aa5c52003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002196- Show boot progress:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002197 CONFIG_SHOW_BOOT_PROGRESS
2198
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002199 Defining this option allows to add some board-
2200 specific code (calling a user-provided function
2201 "show_boot_progress(int)") that enables you to show
2202 the system's boot progress on some display (for
2203 example, some LED's) on your board. At the moment,
2204 the following checkpoints are implemented:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002205
Simon Glass0fa36a42012-09-28 08:56:37 +00002206
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002207Legacy uImage format:
2208
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002209 Arg Where When
2210 1 common/cmd_bootm.c before attempting to boot an image
wdenk544e9732004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002211 -1 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad magic number
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002212 2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct magic number
wdenk544e9732004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002213 -2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002214 3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct checksum
wdenk544e9732004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002215 -3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002216 4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has correct checksum
2217 -4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image is for unsupported architecture
2218 5 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002219 -5 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong Image Type (not kernel, multi)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002220 6 common/cmd_bootm.c Image Type check OK
2221 -6 common/cmd_bootm.c gunzip uncompression error
2222 -7 common/cmd_bootm.c Unimplemented compression type
2223 7 common/cmd_bootm.c Uncompression OK
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002224 8 common/cmd_bootm.c No uncompress/copy overwrite error
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002225 -9 common/cmd_bootm.c Unsupported OS (not Linux, BSD, VxWorks, QNX)
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002226
2227 9 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
2228 -10 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad magic number
2229 -11 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad checksum
2230 10 common/image.c Ramdisk header is OK
2231 -12 common/image.c Ramdisk data has bad checksum
2232 11 common/image.c Ramdisk data has correct checksum
2233 12 common/image.c Ramdisk verification complete, start loading
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002234 -13 common/image.c Wrong Image Type (not PPC Linux ramdisk)
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002235 13 common/image.c Start multifile image verification
2236 14 common/image.c No initial ramdisk, no multifile, continue.
2237
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002238 15 arch/<arch>/lib/bootm.c All preparation done, transferring control to OS
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002239
Stefan Roese88fbf932010-04-15 16:07:28 +02002240 -30 arch/powerpc/lib/board.c Fatal error, hang the system
wdenkd729d302004-02-27 00:07:27 +00002241 -31 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_output_backlog()
2242 -32 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_run_single()
wdenke97d3d92004-02-23 22:22:28 +00002243
Heiko Schocher633e03a2007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002244 34 common/cmd_doc.c before loading a Image from a DOC device
2245 -35 common/cmd_doc.c Bad usage of "doc" command
2246 35 common/cmd_doc.c correct usage of "doc" command
2247 -36 common/cmd_doc.c No boot device
2248 36 common/cmd_doc.c correct boot device
2249 -37 common/cmd_doc.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
2250 37 common/cmd_doc.c correct chip ID found, device available
2251 -38 common/cmd_doc.c Read Error on boot device
2252 38 common/cmd_doc.c reading Image header from DOC device OK
2253 -39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has bad magic number
2254 39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
2255 -40 common/cmd_doc.c Error reading Image from DOC device
2256 40 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
2257 41 common/cmd_ide.c before loading a Image from a IDE device
2258 -42 common/cmd_ide.c Bad usage of "ide" command
2259 42 common/cmd_ide.c correct usage of "ide" command
2260 -43 common/cmd_ide.c No boot device
2261 43 common/cmd_ide.c boot device found
2262 -44 common/cmd_ide.c Device not available
2263 44 common/cmd_ide.c Device available
2264 -45 common/cmd_ide.c wrong partition selected
2265 45 common/cmd_ide.c partition selected
2266 -46 common/cmd_ide.c Unknown partition table
2267 46 common/cmd_ide.c valid partition table found
2268 -47 common/cmd_ide.c Invalid partition type
2269 47 common/cmd_ide.c correct partition type
2270 -48 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
2271 48 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image Header from IDE device OK
2272 -49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad magic number
2273 49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct magic number
2274 -50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad checksum
2275 50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct checksum
2276 -51 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image from IDE device
2277 51 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image from IDE device OK
2278 52 common/cmd_nand.c before loading a Image from a NAND device
2279 -53 common/cmd_nand.c Bad usage of "nand" command
2280 53 common/cmd_nand.c correct usage of "nand" command
2281 -54 common/cmd_nand.c No boot device
2282 54 common/cmd_nand.c boot device found
2283 -55 common/cmd_nand.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
2284 55 common/cmd_nand.c correct chip ID found, device available
2285 -56 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
2286 56 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image Header from NAND device OK
2287 -57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has bad magic number
2288 57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has correct magic number
2289 -58 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image from NAND device
2290 58 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image from NAND device OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002291
Heiko Schocher633e03a2007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002292 -60 common/env_common.c Environment has a bad CRC, using default
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002293
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002294 64 net/eth.c starting with Ethernet configuration.
Heiko Schocher633e03a2007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002295 -64 net/eth.c no Ethernet found.
2296 65 net/eth.c Ethernet found.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002297
Heiko Schocher633e03a2007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002298 -80 common/cmd_net.c usage wrong
Joe Hershbergerc80b41b02015-04-08 01:41:21 -05002299 80 common/cmd_net.c before calling net_loop()
2300 -81 common/cmd_net.c some error in net_loop() occurred
2301 81 common/cmd_net.c net_loop() back without error
Heiko Schocher633e03a2007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002302 -82 common/cmd_net.c size == 0 (File with size 0 loaded)
2303 82 common/cmd_net.c trying automatic boot
Wolfgang Denk85c25df2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002304 83 common/cmd_net.c running "source" command
2305 -83 common/cmd_net.c some error in automatic boot or "source" command
Heiko Schocher633e03a2007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002306 84 common/cmd_net.c end without errors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002307
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002308FIT uImage format:
2309
2310 Arg Where When
2311 100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has correct format
2312 -100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has incorrect format
2313 101 common/cmd_bootm.c No Kernel subimage unit name, using configuration
2314 -101 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get configuration for kernel subimage
2315 102 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel unit name specified
2316 -103 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage node offset
Marian Balakowicz0cd4f3d2008-03-12 10:35:46 +01002317 103 common/cmd_bootm.c Found configuration node
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002318 104 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage node offset
2319 -104 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification failed
2320 105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification OK
2321 -105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage is for unsupported architecture
2322 106 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002323 -106 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage has wrong type
2324 107 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage type OK
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002325 -107 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage data/size
2326 108 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage data/size
2327 -108 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong image type (not legacy, FIT)
2328 -109 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage type
2329 -110 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage comp
2330 -111 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage os
2331 -112 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage load address
2332 -113 common/cmd_bootm.c Image uncompress/copy overwrite error
2333
2334 120 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
2335 -120 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has incorrect format
2336 121 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has correct format
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002337 122 common/image.c No ramdisk subimage unit name, using configuration
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002338 -122 common/image.c Can't get configuration for ramdisk subimage
2339 123 common/image.c Ramdisk unit name specified
2340 -124 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage node offset
2341 125 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage node offset
2342 -125 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification failed
2343 126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification OK
2344 -126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage for unsupported architecture
2345 127 common/image.c Architecture check OK
2346 -127 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage data/size
2347 128 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage data/size
2348 129 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk load address
2349 -129 common/image.c Got ramdisk load address
2350
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002351 -130 common/cmd_doc.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002352 131 common/cmd_doc.c FIT image format OK
2353
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002354 -140 common/cmd_ide.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002355 141 common/cmd_ide.c FIT image format OK
2356
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002357 -150 common/cmd_nand.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002358 151 common/cmd_nand.c FIT image format OK
2359
Wolfgang Denkd590fb12011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002360- Standalone program support:
2361 CONFIG_STANDALONE_LOAD_ADDR
2362
Wolfgang Denk23f78482011-10-09 21:06:34 +02002363 This option defines a board specific value for the
2364 address where standalone program gets loaded, thus
2365 overwriting the architecture dependent default
Wolfgang Denkd590fb12011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002366 settings.
2367
2368- Frame Buffer Address:
2369 CONFIG_FB_ADDR
2370
2371 Define CONFIG_FB_ADDR if you want to use specific
Wolfgang Denka71eb8e2013-01-03 00:43:59 +00002372 address for frame buffer. This is typically the case
2373 when using a graphics controller has separate video
2374 memory. U-Boot will then place the frame buffer at
2375 the given address instead of dynamically reserving it
2376 in system RAM by calling lcd_setmem(), which grabs
2377 the memory for the frame buffer depending on the
2378 configured panel size.
Wolfgang Denkd590fb12011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002379
2380 Please see board_init_f function.
2381
Detlev Zundel0ecb6112009-12-01 17:16:19 +01002382- Automatic software updates via TFTP server
2383 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP
2384 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_CNT_MAX
2385 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_MSEC_MAX
2386
2387 These options enable and control the auto-update feature;
2388 for a more detailed description refer to doc/README.update.
2389
2390- MTD Support (mtdparts command, UBI support)
Heiko Schocherf5895d12014-06-24 10:10:04 +02002391 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_WL_THRESHOLD
2392 This parameter defines the maximum difference between the highest
2393 erase counter value and the lowest erase counter value of eraseblocks
2394 of UBI devices. When this threshold is exceeded, UBI starts performing
2395 wear leveling by means of moving data from eraseblock with low erase
2396 counter to eraseblocks with high erase counter.
2397
2398 The default value should be OK for SLC NAND flashes, NOR flashes and
2399 other flashes which have eraseblock life-cycle 100000 or more.
2400 However, in case of MLC NAND flashes which typically have eraseblock
2401 life-cycle less than 10000, the threshold should be lessened (e.g.,
2402 to 128 or 256, although it does not have to be power of 2).
2403
2404 default: 4096
Simon Glass6c0be912014-10-23 18:58:54 -06002405
Heiko Schocherf5895d12014-06-24 10:10:04 +02002406 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_BEB_LIMIT
2407 This option specifies the maximum bad physical eraseblocks UBI
2408 expects on the MTD device (per 1024 eraseblocks). If the
2409 underlying flash does not admit of bad eraseblocks (e.g. NOR
2410 flash), this value is ignored.
2411
2412 NAND datasheets often specify the minimum and maximum NVM
2413 (Number of Valid Blocks) for the flashes' endurance lifetime.
2414 The maximum expected bad eraseblocks per 1024 eraseblocks
2415 then can be calculated as "1024 * (1 - MinNVB / MaxNVB)",
2416 which gives 20 for most NANDs (MaxNVB is basically the total
2417 count of eraseblocks on the chip).
2418
2419 To put it differently, if this value is 20, UBI will try to
2420 reserve about 1.9% of physical eraseblocks for bad blocks
2421 handling. And that will be 1.9% of eraseblocks on the entire
2422 NAND chip, not just the MTD partition UBI attaches. This means
2423 that if you have, say, a NAND flash chip admits maximum 40 bad
2424 eraseblocks, and it is split on two MTD partitions of the same
2425 size, UBI will reserve 40 eraseblocks when attaching a
2426 partition.
2427
2428 default: 20
2429
2430 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FASTMAP
2431 Fastmap is a mechanism which allows attaching an UBI device
2432 in nearly constant time. Instead of scanning the whole MTD device it
2433 only has to locate a checkpoint (called fastmap) on the device.
2434 The on-flash fastmap contains all information needed to attach
2435 the device. Using fastmap makes only sense on large devices where
2436 attaching by scanning takes long. UBI will not automatically install
2437 a fastmap on old images, but you can set the UBI parameter
2438 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FASTMAP_AUTOCONVERT to 1 if you want so. Please note
2439 that fastmap-enabled images are still usable with UBI implementations
2440 without fastmap support. On typical flash devices the whole fastmap
2441 fits into one PEB. UBI will reserve PEBs to hold two fastmaps.
2442
2443 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FASTMAP_AUTOCONVERT
2444 Set this parameter to enable fastmap automatically on images
2445 without a fastmap.
2446 default: 0
2447
Heiko Schocher94b66de2015-10-22 06:19:21 +02002448 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FM_DEBUG
2449 Enable UBI fastmap debug
2450 default: 0
2451
Daniel Schwierzeck39ca08e2011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002452- SPL framework
Wolfgang Denk825223d2011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002453 CONFIG_SPL
2454 Enable building of SPL globally.
Daniel Schwierzeck39ca08e2011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002455
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002456 CONFIG_SPL_LDSCRIPT
2457 LDSCRIPT for linking the SPL binary.
2458
Albert ARIBAUDe916e052013-04-12 05:14:30 +00002459 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT
2460 Maximum size in memory allocated to the SPL, BSS included.
2461 When defined, the linker checks that the actual memory
2462 used by SPL from _start to __bss_end does not exceed it.
Albert ARIBAUDafab1482013-04-14 04:48:38 +00002463 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT and CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUDe916e052013-04-12 05:14:30 +00002464 must not be both defined at the same time.
2465
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002466 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUDe916e052013-04-12 05:14:30 +00002467 Maximum size of the SPL image (text, data, rodata, and
2468 linker lists sections), BSS excluded.
2469 When defined, the linker checks that the actual size does
2470 not exceed it.
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002471
Wolfgang Denk825223d2011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002472 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE
2473 TEXT_BASE for linking the SPL binary.
Daniel Schwierzeck39ca08e2011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002474
Scott Woodc4f0d002012-09-20 19:05:12 -05002475 CONFIG_SPL_RELOC_TEXT_BASE
2476 Address to relocate to. If unspecified, this is equal to
2477 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE (i.e. no relocation is done).
2478
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002479 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_START_ADDR
2480 Link address for the BSS within the SPL binary.
2481
2482 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUDe916e052013-04-12 05:14:30 +00002483 Maximum size in memory allocated to the SPL BSS.
2484 When defined, the linker checks that the actual memory used
2485 by SPL from __bss_start to __bss_end does not exceed it.
Albert ARIBAUDafab1482013-04-14 04:48:38 +00002486 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT and CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUDe916e052013-04-12 05:14:30 +00002487 must not be both defined at the same time.
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002488
2489 CONFIG_SPL_STACK
2490 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use
2491
Albert ARIBAUD \(3ADEV\)287b0942015-03-31 11:40:50 +02002492 CONFIG_SPL_PANIC_ON_RAW_IMAGE
2493 When defined, SPL will panic() if the image it has
2494 loaded does not have a signature.
2495 Defining this is useful when code which loads images
2496 in SPL cannot guarantee that absolutely all read errors
2497 will be caught.
2498 An example is the LPC32XX MLC NAND driver, which will
2499 consider that a completely unreadable NAND block is bad,
2500 and thus should be skipped silently.
2501
Scott Woodc4f0d002012-09-20 19:05:12 -05002502 CONFIG_SPL_RELOC_STACK
2503 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use after
2504 relocation. If unspecified, this is equal to
2505 CONFIG_SPL_STACK.
2506
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002507 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_START
2508 Starting address of the malloc pool used in SPL.
Fabio Estevam38e1a972015-11-12 12:30:19 -02002509 When this option is set the full malloc is used in SPL and
2510 it is set up by spl_init() and before that, the simple malloc()
2511 can be used if CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_F is defined.
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002512
2513 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_SIZE
2514 The size of the malloc pool used in SPL.
Daniel Schwierzeck39ca08e2011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002515
Tom Rinic2b76002014-03-28 12:03:39 -04002516 CONFIG_SPL_OS_BOOT
2517 Enable booting directly to an OS from SPL.
2518 See also: doc/README.falcon
2519
Tom Rinife3b0c72012-08-13 11:37:56 -07002520 CONFIG_SPL_DISPLAY_PRINT
2521 For ARM, enable an optional function to print more information
2522 about the running system.
2523
Scott Wood7c810902012-09-20 16:35:21 -05002524 CONFIG_SPL_INIT_MINIMAL
2525 Arch init code should be built for a very small image
2526
Paul Kocialkowski17675c82014-11-08 23:14:56 +01002527 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_U_BOOT_PARTITION
2528 Partition on the MMC to load U-Boot from when the MMC is being
2529 used in raw mode
2530
Peter Korsgaard01b542f2013-05-13 08:36:29 +00002531 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_KERNEL_SECTOR
2532 Sector to load kernel uImage from when MMC is being
2533 used in raw mode (for Falcon mode)
2534
2535 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_ARGS_SECTOR,
2536 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_ARGS_SECTORS
2537 Sector and number of sectors to load kernel argument
2538 parameters from when MMC is being used in raw mode
2539 (for falcon mode)
2540
Paul Kocialkowski341e8cd2014-11-08 23:14:55 +01002541 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_FS_BOOT_PARTITION
2542 Partition on the MMC to load U-Boot from when the MMC is being
2543 used in fs mode
2544
Guillaume GARDET5065b712014-10-15 17:53:13 +02002545 CONFIG_SPL_FS_LOAD_PAYLOAD_NAME
2546 Filename to read to load U-Boot when reading from filesystem
2547
2548 CONFIG_SPL_FS_LOAD_KERNEL_NAME
Peter Korsgaard465f1f82013-05-13 08:36:27 +00002549 Filename to read to load kernel uImage when reading
Guillaume GARDET5065b712014-10-15 17:53:13 +02002550 from filesystem (for Falcon mode)
Peter Korsgaard465f1f82013-05-13 08:36:27 +00002551
Guillaume GARDET5065b712014-10-15 17:53:13 +02002552 CONFIG_SPL_FS_LOAD_ARGS_NAME
Peter Korsgaard465f1f82013-05-13 08:36:27 +00002553 Filename to read to load kernel argument parameters
Guillaume GARDET5065b712014-10-15 17:53:13 +02002554 when reading from filesystem (for Falcon mode)
Peter Korsgaard465f1f82013-05-13 08:36:27 +00002555
Scott Wood2b36fbb2012-12-06 13:33:17 +00002556 CONFIG_SPL_MPC83XX_WAIT_FOR_NAND
2557 Set this for NAND SPL on PPC mpc83xx targets, so that
2558 start.S waits for the rest of the SPL to load before
2559 continuing (the hardware starts execution after just
2560 loading the first page rather than the full 4K).
2561
Prabhakar Kushwaha6e2b9a32014-04-08 19:12:31 +05302562 CONFIG_SPL_SKIP_RELOCATE
2563 Avoid SPL relocation
2564
Scott Woodc352a0c2012-09-20 19:09:07 -05002565 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_BASE
2566 Include nand_base.c in the SPL. Requires
2567 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_DRIVERS.
2568
2569 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_DRIVERS
2570 SPL uses normal NAND drivers, not minimal drivers.
2571
Jörg Krause6f8190f2018-01-14 19:26:38 +01002572 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_IDENT
2573 SPL uses the chip ID list to identify the NAND flash.
2574 Requires CONFIG_SPL_NAND_BASE.
2575
Scott Woodc352a0c2012-09-20 19:09:07 -05002576 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_ECC
2577 Include standard software ECC in the SPL
2578
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002579 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_SIMPLE
Scott Wood36c440e2012-09-21 18:35:27 -05002580 Support for NAND boot using simple NAND drivers that
2581 expose the cmd_ctrl() interface.
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002582
Thomas Gleixner820d24d2016-07-12 20:28:12 +02002583 CONFIG_SPL_UBI
2584 Support for a lightweight UBI (fastmap) scanner and
2585 loader
2586
Heiko Schochercf000272014-10-31 08:31:00 +01002587 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_RAW_ONLY
2588 Support to boot only raw u-boot.bin images. Use this only
2589 if you need to save space.
2590
Ying Zhangdfb2b152013-08-16 15:16:12 +08002591 CONFIG_SPL_COMMON_INIT_DDR
2592 Set for common ddr init with serial presence detect in
2593 SPL binary.
2594
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002595 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_5_ADDR_CYCLE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_COUNT,
2596 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_OOBSIZE,
2597 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BLOCK_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BAD_BLOCK_POS,
2598 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCPOS, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCSIZE,
2599 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCBYTES
2600 Defines the size and behavior of the NAND that SPL uses
Scott Wood36c440e2012-09-21 18:35:27 -05002601 to read U-Boot
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002602
Prabhakar Kushwahaafffcb02013-12-11 12:42:11 +05302603 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_BOOT
2604 Add support NAND boot
2605
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002606 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_OFFS
Scott Wood36c440e2012-09-21 18:35:27 -05002607 Location in NAND to read U-Boot from
2608
2609 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_DST
2610 Location in memory to load U-Boot to
2611
2612 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_SIZE
2613 Size of image to load
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002614
2615 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_START
Scott Wood36c440e2012-09-21 18:35:27 -05002616 Entry point in loaded image to jump to
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002617
2618 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_HW_ECC_OOBFIRST
2619 Define this if you need to first read the OOB and then the
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002620 data. This is used, for example, on davinci platforms.
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002621
Pavel Machekde997252012-08-30 22:42:11 +02002622 CONFIG_SPL_RAM_DEVICE
2623 Support for running image already present in ram, in SPL binary
2624
Scott Woodeb7bd972012-12-06 13:33:16 +00002625 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO
Benoît Thébaudeauf0180722013-04-11 09:35:49 +00002626 Image offset to which the SPL should be padded before appending
2627 the SPL payload. By default, this is defined as
2628 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE, or 0 if CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE is undefined.
2629 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO must be either 0, meaning to append the SPL
2630 payload without any padding, or >= CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE.
Scott Woodeb7bd972012-12-06 13:33:16 +00002631
Scott Woodf147eb72012-09-21 16:27:32 -05002632 CONFIG_SPL_TARGET
2633 Final target image containing SPL and payload. Some SPLs
2634 use an arch-specific makefile fragment instead, for
2635 example if more than one image needs to be produced.
2636
Marek Vasut9f2e0eb2018-05-13 00:22:52 +02002637 CONFIG_SPL_FIT_PRINT
Simon Glass82d94532013-05-08 08:05:59 +00002638 Printing information about a FIT image adds quite a bit of
2639 code to SPL. So this is normally disabled in SPL. Use this
2640 option to re-enable it. This will affect the output of the
2641 bootm command when booting a FIT image.
2642
Ying Zhang2d2e3b62013-08-16 15:16:15 +08002643- TPL framework
2644 CONFIG_TPL
2645 Enable building of TPL globally.
2646
2647 CONFIG_TPL_PAD_TO
2648 Image offset to which the TPL should be padded before appending
2649 the TPL payload. By default, this is defined as
Wolfgang Denkec7fbf52013-10-04 17:43:24 +02002650 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE, or 0 if CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE is undefined.
2651 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO must be either 0, meaning to append the SPL
2652 payload without any padding, or >= CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE.
Ying Zhang2d2e3b62013-08-16 15:16:15 +08002653
wdenkc0aa5c52003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002654- Interrupt support (PPC):
2655
wdenk1ebf41e2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002656 There are common interrupt_init() and timer_interrupt()
2657 for all PPC archs. interrupt_init() calls interrupt_init_cpu()
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002658 for CPU specific initialization. interrupt_init_cpu()
wdenk1ebf41e2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002659 should set decrementer_count to appropriate value. If
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002660 CPU resets decrementer automatically after interrupt
wdenk1ebf41e2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002661 (ppc4xx) it should set decrementer_count to zero.
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002662 timer_interrupt() calls timer_interrupt_cpu() for CPU
wdenk1ebf41e2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002663 specific handling. If board has watchdog / status_led
2664 / other_activity_monitor it works automatically from
2665 general timer_interrupt().
wdenkc0aa5c52003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002666
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002667
Helmut Raigerd5a184b2011-10-20 04:19:47 +00002668Board initialization settings:
2669------------------------------
2670
2671During Initialization u-boot calls a number of board specific functions
2672to allow the preparation of board specific prerequisites, e.g. pin setup
2673before drivers are initialized. To enable these callbacks the
2674following configuration macros have to be defined. Currently this is
2675architecture specific, so please check arch/your_architecture/lib/board.c
2676typically in board_init_f() and board_init_r().
2677
2678- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_F: Call board_early_init_f()
2679- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_R: Call board_early_init_r()
2680- CONFIG_BOARD_LATE_INIT: Call board_late_init()
2681- CONFIG_BOARD_POSTCLK_INIT: Call board_postclk_init()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002682
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002683Configuration Settings:
2684-----------------------
2685
York Sun6c480012014-02-26 17:03:19 -08002686- CONFIG_SYS_SUPPORT_64BIT_DATA: Defined automatically if compiled as 64-bit.
2687 Optionally it can be defined to support 64-bit memory commands.
2688
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002689- CONFIG_SYS_LONGHELP: Defined when you want long help messages included;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002690 undefine this when you're short of memory.
2691
Peter Tyserdfb72b82009-01-27 18:03:12 -06002692- CONFIG_SYS_HELP_CMD_WIDTH: Defined when you want to override the default
2693 width of the commands listed in the 'help' command output.
2694
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002695- CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT: This is what U-Boot prints on the console to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002696 prompt for user input.
2697
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002698- CONFIG_SYS_CBSIZE: Buffer size for input from the Console
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002699
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002700- CONFIG_SYS_PBSIZE: Buffer size for Console output
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002701
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002702- CONFIG_SYS_MAXARGS: max. Number of arguments accepted for monitor commands
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002703
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002704- CONFIG_SYS_BARGSIZE: Buffer size for Boot Arguments which are passed to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002705 the application (usually a Linux kernel) when it is
2706 booted
2707
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002708- CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002709 List of legal baudrate settings for this board.
2710
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002711- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_START, CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_END:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002712 Begin and End addresses of the area used by the
2713 simple memory test.
2714
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002715- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_SCRATCH:
wdenk5958f4a2003-09-18 09:21:33 +00002716 Scratch address used by the alternate memory test
2717 You only need to set this if address zero isn't writeable
2718
York Sun5d286cd2015-12-04 11:57:07 -08002719- CONFIG_SYS_MEM_RESERVE_SECURE
York Sun1ef95cc2016-06-24 16:46:18 -07002720 Only implemented for ARMv8 for now.
York Sun5d286cd2015-12-04 11:57:07 -08002721 If defined, the size of CONFIG_SYS_MEM_RESERVE_SECURE memory
2722 is substracted from total RAM and won't be reported to OS.
2723 This memory can be used as secure memory. A variable
York Sun1ef95cc2016-06-24 16:46:18 -07002724 gd->arch.secure_ram is used to track the location. In systems
York Sun5d286cd2015-12-04 11:57:07 -08002725 the RAM base is not zero, or RAM is divided into banks,
2726 this variable needs to be recalcuated to get the address.
2727
York Sun50739372015-12-07 11:05:29 -08002728- CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002729 If CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE is defined in the board config header,
Stefan Roesea13709f2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01002730 this specified memory area will get subtracted from the top
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002731 (end) of RAM and won't get "touched" at all by U-Boot. By
Stefan Roesea13709f2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01002732 fixing up gd->ram_size the Linux kernel should gets passed
2733 the now "corrected" memory size and won't touch it either.
2734 This should work for arch/ppc and arch/powerpc. Only Linux
Stefan Roese37f31bf2008-03-28 11:02:53 +01002735 board ports in arch/powerpc with bootwrapper support that
Stefan Roesea13709f2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01002736 recalculate the memory size from the SDRAM controller setup
Stefan Roese37f31bf2008-03-28 11:02:53 +01002737 will have to get fixed in Linux additionally.
Stefan Roesea13709f2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01002738
2739 This option can be used as a workaround for the 440EPx/GRx
2740 CHIP 11 errata where the last 256 bytes in SDRAM shouldn't
2741 be touched.
2742
2743 WARNING: Please make sure that this value is a multiple of
2744 the Linux page size (normally 4k). If this is not the case,
2745 then the end address of the Linux memory will be located at a
2746 non page size aligned address and this could cause major
2747 problems.
2748
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002749- CONFIG_SYS_LOADS_BAUD_CHANGE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002750 Enable temporary baudrate change while serial download
2751
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002752- CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002753 Physical start address of SDRAM. _Must_ be 0 here.
2754
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002755- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002756 Physical start address of Flash memory.
2757
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002758- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002759 Physical start address of boot monitor code (set by
2760 make config files to be same as the text base address
Wolfgang Denk0708bc62010-10-07 21:51:12 +02002761 (CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE) used when linking) - same as
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002762 CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE when booting from flash.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002763
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002764- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_LEN:
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002765 Size of memory reserved for monitor code, used to
2766 determine _at_compile_time_ (!) if the environment is
2767 embedded within the U-Boot image, or in a separate
2768 flash sector.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002769
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002770- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002771 Size of DRAM reserved for malloc() use.
2772
Simon Glass863e4042014-07-10 22:23:28 -06002773- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN
2774 Size of the malloc() pool for use before relocation. If
2775 this is defined, then a very simple malloc() implementation
2776 will become available before relocation. The address is just
2777 below the global data, and the stack is moved down to make
2778 space.
2779
2780 This feature allocates regions with increasing addresses
2781 within the region. calloc() is supported, but realloc()
2782 is not available. free() is supported but does nothing.
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002783 The memory will be freed (or in fact just forgotten) when
Simon Glass863e4042014-07-10 22:23:28 -06002784 U-Boot relocates itself.
2785
Simon Glass9fa901b2014-11-10 17:16:54 -07002786- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_SIMPLE
2787 Provides a simple and small malloc() and calloc() for those
2788 boards which do not use the full malloc in SPL (which is
2789 enabled with CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_START).
2790
Thierry Redingc97d9742014-12-09 22:25:22 -07002791- CONFIG_SYS_NONCACHED_MEMORY:
2792 Size of non-cached memory area. This area of memory will be
2793 typically located right below the malloc() area and mapped
2794 uncached in the MMU. This is useful for drivers that would
2795 otherwise require a lot of explicit cache maintenance. For
2796 some drivers it's also impossible to properly maintain the
2797 cache. For example if the regions that need to be flushed
2798 are not a multiple of the cache-line size, *and* padding
2799 cannot be allocated between the regions to align them (i.e.
2800 if the HW requires a contiguous array of regions, and the
2801 size of each region is not cache-aligned), then a flush of
2802 one region may result in overwriting data that hardware has
2803 written to another region in the same cache-line. This can
2804 happen for example in network drivers where descriptors for
2805 buffers are typically smaller than the CPU cache-line (e.g.
2806 16 bytes vs. 32 or 64 bytes).
2807
2808 Non-cached memory is only supported on 32-bit ARM at present.
2809
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002810- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN:
Stefan Roese5d5ce292006-03-13 11:16:36 +01002811 Normally compressed uImages are limited to an
2812 uncompressed size of 8 MBytes. If this is not enough,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002813 you can define CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN in your board config file
Stefan Roese5d5ce292006-03-13 11:16:36 +01002814 to adjust this setting to your needs.
2815
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002816- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002817 Maximum size of memory mapped by the startup code of
2818 the Linux kernel; all data that must be processed by
Bartlomiej Siekac5648c82008-04-14 15:44:16 +02002819 the Linux kernel (bd_info, boot arguments, FDT blob if
2820 used) must be put below this limit, unless "bootm_low"
Robert P. J. Day832d36e2013-09-16 07:15:45 -04002821 environment variable is defined and non-zero. In such case
Bartlomiej Siekac5648c82008-04-14 15:44:16 +02002822 all data for the Linux kernel must be between "bootm_low"
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002823 and "bootm_low" + CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. The environment
Grant Likely26396382011-03-28 09:58:43 +00002824 variable "bootm_mapsize" will override the value of
2825 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. If CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is undefined,
2826 then the value in "bootm_size" will be used instead.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002827
John Rigbyeea8e692010-10-13 13:57:35 -06002828- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_RAMDISK_HIGH:
2829 Enable initrd_high functionality. If defined then the
2830 initrd_high feature is enabled and the bootm ramdisk subcommand
2831 is enabled.
2832
2833- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_CMDLINE:
2834 Enables allocating and saving kernel cmdline in space between
2835 "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
2836
2837- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_KBD:
2838 Enables allocating and saving a kernel copy of the bd_info in
2839 space between "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
2840
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002841- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002842 Max number of Flash memory banks
2843
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002844- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_SECT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002845 Max number of sectors on a Flash chip
2846
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002847- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_ERASE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002848 Timeout for Flash erase operations (in ms)
2849
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002850- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_WRITE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002851 Timeout for Flash write operations (in ms)
2852
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002853- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_LOCK_TOUT
wdenkdccbda02003-07-14 22:13:32 +00002854 Timeout for Flash set sector lock bit operation (in ms)
2855
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002856- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_UNLOCK_TOUT
wdenkdccbda02003-07-14 22:13:32 +00002857 Timeout for Flash clear lock bits operation (in ms)
2858
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002859- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_PROTECTION
wdenkdccbda02003-07-14 22:13:32 +00002860 If defined, hardware flash sectors protection is used
2861 instead of U-Boot software protection.
2862
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002863- CONFIG_SYS_DIRECT_FLASH_TFTP:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002864
2865 Enable TFTP transfers directly to flash memory;
2866 without this option such a download has to be
2867 performed in two steps: (1) download to RAM, and (2)
2868 copy from RAM to flash.
2869
2870 The two-step approach is usually more reliable, since
2871 you can check if the download worked before you erase
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002872 the flash, but in some situations (when system RAM is
2873 too limited to allow for a temporary copy of the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002874 downloaded image) this option may be very useful.
2875
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002876- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_CFI:
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002877 Define if the flash driver uses extra elements in the
wdenk2cefd152004-02-08 22:55:38 +00002878 common flash structure for storing flash geometry.
2879
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD8d94c232008-08-13 01:40:42 +02002880- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_DRIVER
wdenk2cefd152004-02-08 22:55:38 +00002881 This option also enables the building of the cfi_flash driver
2882 in the drivers directory
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002883
Piotr Ziecik3e939e92008-11-17 15:57:58 +01002884- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_MTD
2885 This option enables the building of the cfi_mtd driver
2886 in the drivers directory. The driver exports CFI flash
2887 to the MTD layer.
2888
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002889- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_USE_BUFFER_WRITE
Guennadi Liakhovetski183284f2008-04-03 13:36:02 +02002890 Use buffered writes to flash.
2891
2892- CONFIG_FLASH_SPANSION_S29WS_N
2893 s29ws-n MirrorBit flash has non-standard addresses for buffered
2894 write commands.
2895
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002896- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_QUIET_TEST
Stefan Roesec443fe92005-11-22 13:20:42 +01002897 If this option is defined, the common CFI flash doesn't
2898 print it's warning upon not recognized FLASH banks. This
2899 is useful, if some of the configured banks are only
2900 optionally available.
2901
Jerry Van Barenaae73572008-03-08 13:48:01 -05002902- CONFIG_FLASH_SHOW_PROGRESS
2903 If defined (must be an integer), print out countdown
2904 digits and dots. Recommended value: 45 (9..1) for 80
2905 column displays, 15 (3..1) for 40 column displays.
2906
Stefan Roesed20cba52013-04-04 15:53:14 +02002907- CONFIG_FLASH_VERIFY
2908 If defined, the content of the flash (destination) is compared
2909 against the source after the write operation. An error message
2910 will be printed when the contents are not identical.
2911 Please note that this option is useless in nearly all cases,
2912 since such flash programming errors usually are detected earlier
2913 while unprotecting/erasing/programming. Please only enable
2914 this option if you really know what you are doing.
2915
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002916- CONFIG_SYS_RX_ETH_BUFFER:
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002917 Defines the number of Ethernet receive buffers. On some
2918 Ethernet controllers it is recommended to set this value
stroese94ef1cf2003-06-05 15:39:44 +00002919 to 8 or even higher (EEPRO100 or 405 EMAC), since all
2920 buffers can be full shortly after enabling the interface
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002921 on high Ethernet traffic.
stroese94ef1cf2003-06-05 15:39:44 +00002922 Defaults to 4 if not defined.
2923
Wolfgang Denk460a9ff2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02002924- CONFIG_ENV_MAX_ENTRIES
2925
Wolfgang Denk1136f692010-10-27 22:48:30 +02002926 Maximum number of entries in the hash table that is used
2927 internally to store the environment settings. The default
2928 setting is supposed to be generous and should work in most
2929 cases. This setting can be used to tune behaviour; see
2930 lib/hashtable.c for details.
Wolfgang Denk460a9ff2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02002931
Joe Hershberger71497d02012-12-11 22:16:31 -06002932- CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_DEFAULT
2933- CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC
Robert P. J. Day832d36e2013-09-16 07:15:45 -04002934 Enable validation of the values given to environment variables when
Joe Hershberger71497d02012-12-11 22:16:31 -06002935 calling env set. Variables can be restricted to only decimal,
2936 hexadecimal, or boolean. If CONFIG_CMD_NET is also defined,
2937 the variables can also be restricted to IP address or MAC address.
2938
2939 The format of the list is:
2940 type_attribute = [s|d|x|b|i|m]
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002941 access_attribute = [a|r|o|c]
2942 attributes = type_attribute[access_attribute]
Joe Hershberger71497d02012-12-11 22:16:31 -06002943 entry = variable_name[:attributes]
2944 list = entry[,list]
2945
2946 The type attributes are:
2947 s - String (default)
2948 d - Decimal
2949 x - Hexadecimal
2950 b - Boolean ([1yYtT|0nNfF])
2951 i - IP address
2952 m - MAC address
2953
Joe Hershberger6fe26c92012-12-11 22:16:34 -06002954 The access attributes are:
2955 a - Any (default)
2956 r - Read-only
2957 o - Write-once
2958 c - Change-default
2959
Joe Hershberger71497d02012-12-11 22:16:31 -06002960 - CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_DEFAULT
2961 Define this to a list (string) to define the ".flags"
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002962 environment variable in the default or embedded environment.
Joe Hershberger71497d02012-12-11 22:16:31 -06002963
2964 - CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC
2965 Define this to a list (string) to define validation that
2966 should be done if an entry is not found in the ".flags"
2967 environment variable. To override a setting in the static
2968 list, simply add an entry for the same variable name to the
2969 ".flags" variable.
2970
Joe Hershberger6db9fd42015-05-20 14:27:20 -05002971 If CONFIG_REGEX is defined, the variable_name above is evaluated as a
2972 regular expression. This allows multiple variables to define the same
2973 flags without explicitly listing them for each variable.
2974
Joe Hershberger6fe26c92012-12-11 22:16:34 -06002975- CONFIG_ENV_ACCESS_IGNORE_FORCE
2976 If defined, don't allow the -f switch to env set override variable
2977 access flags.
2978
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002979The following definitions that deal with the placement and management
2980of environment data (variable area); in general, we support the
2981following configurations:
2982
Mike Frysinger63b8f122011-07-08 10:44:25 +00002983- CONFIG_BUILD_ENVCRC:
2984
2985 Builds up envcrc with the target environment so that external utils
2986 may easily extract it and embed it in final U-Boot images.
2987
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002988BE CAREFUL! The first access to the environment happens quite early
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002989in U-Boot initialization (when we try to get the setting of for the
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002990console baudrate). You *MUST* have mapped your NVRAM area then, or
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002991U-Boot will hang.
2992
2993Please note that even with NVRAM we still use a copy of the
2994environment in RAM: we could work on NVRAM directly, but we want to
2995keep settings there always unmodified except somebody uses "saveenv"
2996to save the current settings.
2997
Liu Gang85bcd732012-03-08 00:33:20 +00002998BE CAREFUL! For some special cases, the local device can not use
2999"saveenv" command. For example, the local device will get the
Liu Gang357bf5a2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003000environment stored in a remote NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE link,
3001but it can not erase, write this NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE interface.
Liu Gang85bcd732012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003002
Guennadi Liakhovetskifad24442009-05-18 16:07:22 +02003003- CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST
3004
3005 Defines address in RAM to which the nand_spl code should copy the
3006 environment. If redundant environment is used, it will be copied to
3007 CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST + CONFIG_ENV_SIZE.
3008
Bruce Adleredecc942007-11-02 13:15:42 -07003009Please note that the environment is read-only until the monitor
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003010has been relocated to RAM and a RAM copy of the environment has been
Simon Glass64b723f2017-08-03 12:22:12 -06003011created; also, when using EEPROM you will have to use env_get_f()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003012until then to read environment variables.
3013
wdenk8dba0502003-03-31 16:34:49 +00003014The environment is protected by a CRC32 checksum. Before the monitor
3015is relocated into RAM, as a result of a bad CRC you will be working
3016with the compiled-in default environment - *silently*!!! [This is
3017necessary, because the first environment variable we need is the
3018"baudrate" setting for the console - if we have a bad CRC, we don't
3019have any device yet where we could complain.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003020
3021Note: once the monitor has been relocated, then it will complain if
3022the default environment is used; a new CRC is computed as soon as you
wdenk8dba0502003-03-31 16:34:49 +00003023use the "saveenv" command to store a valid environment.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003024
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003025- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_ECHO_LINK_DOWN:
wdenk9c53f402003-10-15 23:53:47 +00003026 Echo the inverted Ethernet link state to the fault LED.
wdenk49c3f672003-10-08 22:33:00 +00003027
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003028 Note: If this option is active, then CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR
wdenk49c3f672003-10-08 22:33:00 +00003029 also needs to be defined.
3030
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003031- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR:
wdenk9c53f402003-10-15 23:53:47 +00003032 MII address of the PHY to check for the Ethernet link state.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003033
Ron Madriddfa028a2009-02-18 14:30:44 -08003034- CONFIG_NS16550_MIN_FUNCTIONS:
3035 Define this if you desire to only have use of the NS16550_init
3036 and NS16550_putc functions for the serial driver located at
3037 drivers/serial/ns16550.c. This option is useful for saving
3038 space for already greatly restricted images, including but not
3039 limited to NAND_SPL configurations.
3040
Simon Glass28a9e332012-11-30 13:01:18 +00003041- CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO
3042 Display information about the board that U-Boot is running on
3043 when U-Boot starts up. The board function checkboard() is called
3044 to do this.
3045
Simon Glasse8822012012-11-30 13:01:19 +00003046- CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO_LATE
3047 Similar to the previous option, but display this information
3048 later, once stdio is running and output goes to the LCD, if
3049 present.
3050
Sascha Silbe4b9c17c2013-08-11 16:40:43 +02003051- CONFIG_BOARD_SIZE_LIMIT:
3052 Maximum size of the U-Boot image. When defined, the
3053 build system checks that the actual size does not
3054 exceed it.
3055
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003056Low Level (hardware related) configuration options:
wdenkc8434db2003-03-26 06:55:25 +00003057---------------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003058
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003059- CONFIG_SYS_CACHELINE_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003060 Cache Line Size of the CPU.
3061
Timur Tabid8f341c2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003062- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT:
3063 Default (power-on reset) physical address of CCSR on Freescale
3064 PowerPC SOCs.
3065
3066- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR:
3067 Virtual address of CCSR. On a 32-bit build, this is typically
3068 the same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT.
3069
Timur Tabid8f341c2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003070- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS:
3071 Physical address of CCSR. CCSR can be relocated to a new
3072 physical address, if desired. In this case, this macro should
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003073 be set to that address. Otherwise, it should be set to the
Timur Tabid8f341c2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003074 same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT. For example, CCSR
3075 is typically relocated on 36-bit builds. It is recommended
3076 that this macro be defined via the _HIGH and _LOW macros:
3077
3078 #define CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS ((CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH
3079 * 1ull) << 32 | CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW)
3080
3081- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH:
Wolfgang Denkd590fb12011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003082 Bits 33-36 of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This value is typically
3083 either 0 (32-bit build) or 0xF (36-bit build). This macro is
Timur Tabid8f341c2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003084 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
3085 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
3086
3087- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW:
3088 Lower 32-bits of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This macro is
3089 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
3090 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
3091
3092- CONFIG_SYS_CCSR_DO_NOT_RELOCATE:
3093 If this macro is defined, then CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS will be
3094 forced to a value that ensures that CCSR is not relocated.
3095
wdenk1272e232002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003096- Floppy Disk Support:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003097 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER
wdenk1272e232002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003098
3099 the default drive number (default value 0)
3100
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003101 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE
wdenk1272e232002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003102
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003103 defines the spacing between FDC chipset registers
wdenk1272e232002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003104 (default value 1)
3105
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003106 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET
wdenk1272e232002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003107
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003108 defines the offset of register from address. It
3109 depends on which part of the data bus is connected to
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003110 the FDC chipset. (default value 0)
wdenk1272e232002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003111
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003112 If CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET and
3113 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER are undefined, they take their
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003114 default value.
wdenk1272e232002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003115
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003116 if CONFIG_SYS_FDC_HW_INIT is defined, then the function
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003117 fdc_hw_init() is called at the beginning of the FDC
3118 setup. fdc_hw_init() must be provided by the board
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003119 source code. It is used to make hardware-dependent
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003120 initializations.
wdenk1272e232002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003121
Macpaul Lind1e49942011-04-11 20:45:32 +00003122- CONFIG_IDE_AHB:
3123 Most IDE controllers were designed to be connected with PCI
3124 interface. Only few of them were designed for AHB interface.
3125 When software is doing ATA command and data transfer to
3126 IDE devices through IDE-AHB controller, some additional
3127 registers accessing to these kind of IDE-AHB controller
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003128 is required.
Macpaul Lind1e49942011-04-11 20:45:32 +00003129
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003130- CONFIG_SYS_IMMR: Physical address of the Internal Memory.
wdenk07d7e6b2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003131 DO NOT CHANGE unless you know exactly what you're
Christophe Leroy069fa832017-07-06 10:23:22 +02003132 doing! (11-4) [MPC8xx systems only]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003133
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003134- CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003135
wdenkeb20ad32003-09-05 23:19:14 +00003136 Start address of memory area that can be used for
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003137 initial data and stack; please note that this must be
3138 writable memory that is working WITHOUT special
3139 initialization, i. e. you CANNOT use normal RAM which
3140 will become available only after programming the
3141 memory controller and running certain initialization
3142 sequences.
3143
3144 U-Boot uses the following memory types:
Christophe Leroy069fa832017-07-06 10:23:22 +02003145 - MPC8xx: IMMR (internal memory of the CPU)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003146
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003147- CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003148
3149 Offset of the initial data structure in the memory
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003150 area defined by CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR. Usually
3151 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET is chosen such that the initial
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003152 data is located at the end of the available space
Wolfgang Denk1c2e98e2010-10-26 13:32:32 +02003153 (sometimes written as (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_SIZE -
Simon Glass9a6ac8b2016-10-02 18:01:06 -06003154 GENERATED_GBL_DATA_SIZE), and the initial stack is just
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003155 below that area (growing from (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR +
3156 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET) downward.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003157
3158 Note:
3159 On the MPC824X (or other systems that use the data
3160 cache for initial memory) the address chosen for
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003161 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR is basically arbitrary - it must
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003162 point to an otherwise UNUSED address space between
3163 the top of RAM and the start of the PCI space.
3164
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003165- CONFIG_SYS_SCCR: System Clock and reset Control Register (15-27)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003166
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003167- CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003168 SDRAM timing
3169
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003170- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003171 periodic timer for refresh
3172
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003173- FLASH_BASE0_PRELIM, FLASH_BASE1_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_REMAP_OR_AM,
3174 CONFIG_SYS_PRELIM_OR_AM, CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_FLASH, CONFIG_SYS_OR0_REMAP,
3175 CONFIG_SYS_OR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_REMAP, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_PRELIM,
3176 CONFIG_SYS_BR1_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003177 Memory Controller Definitions: BR0/1 and OR0/1 (FLASH)
3178
3179- SDRAM_BASE2_PRELIM, SDRAM_BASE3_PRELIM, SDRAM_MAX_SIZE,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003180 CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM, CONFIG_SYS_OR2_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR2_PRELIM,
3181 CONFIG_SYS_OR3_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR3_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003182 Memory Controller Definitions: BR2/3 and OR2/3 (SDRAM)
3183
Andrew Sharp61d47ca2012-08-29 14:16:32 +00003184- CONFIG_PCI_ENUM_ONLY
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003185 Only scan through and get the devices on the buses.
Andrew Sharp61d47ca2012-08-29 14:16:32 +00003186 Don't do any setup work, presumably because someone or
3187 something has already done it, and we don't need to do it
3188 a second time. Useful for platforms that are pre-booted
3189 by coreboot or similar.
3190
Gabor Juhosb4458732013-05-30 07:06:12 +00003191- CONFIG_PCI_INDIRECT_BRIDGE:
3192 Enable support for indirect PCI bridges.
3193
Kumar Gala8975d7a2010-12-30 12:09:53 -06003194- CONFIG_SYS_SRIO:
3195 Chip has SRIO or not
3196
3197- CONFIG_SRIO1:
3198 Board has SRIO 1 port available
3199
3200- CONFIG_SRIO2:
3201 Board has SRIO 2 port available
3202
Liu Gang27afb9c2013-05-07 16:30:46 +08003203- CONFIG_SRIO_PCIE_BOOT_MASTER
3204 Board can support master function for Boot from SRIO and PCIE
3205
Kumar Gala8975d7a2010-12-30 12:09:53 -06003206- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_VIRT:
3207 Virtual Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3208
3209- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_PHYS:
3210 Physical Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3211
3212- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_SIZE:
3213 Size of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3214
Fabio Estevamf17e8782013-04-11 09:35:34 +00003215- CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BUSWIDTH_16BIT
3216 Defined to tell the NAND controller that the NAND chip is using
3217 a 16 bit bus.
3218 Not all NAND drivers use this symbol.
Fabio Estevam417052b2013-04-11 09:35:35 +00003219 Example of drivers that use it:
Miquel Raynal1f1ae152018-08-16 17:30:07 +02003220 - drivers/mtd/nand/raw/ndfc.c
3221 - drivers/mtd/nand/raw/mxc_nand.c
Alex Watermancd6aae32011-05-19 15:08:36 -04003222
3223- CONFIG_SYS_NDFC_EBC0_CFG
3224 Sets the EBC0_CFG register for the NDFC. If not defined
3225 a default value will be used.
3226
Ben Warren45657152006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003227- CONFIG_SPD_EEPROM
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003228 Get DDR timing information from an I2C EEPROM. Common
3229 with pluggable memory modules such as SODIMMs
3230
Ben Warren45657152006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003231 SPD_EEPROM_ADDRESS
3232 I2C address of the SPD EEPROM
3233
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003234- CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003235 If SPD EEPROM is on an I2C bus other than the first
3236 one, specify here. Note that the value must resolve
3237 to something your driver can deal with.
Ben Warren45657152006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003238
York Sune73cc042011-06-07 09:42:16 +08003239- CONFIG_SYS_DDR_RAW_TIMING
3240 Get DDR timing information from other than SPD. Common with
3241 soldered DDR chips onboard without SPD. DDR raw timing
3242 parameters are extracted from datasheet and hard-coded into
3243 header files or board specific files.
3244
York Sunbd495cf2011-09-16 13:21:35 -07003245- CONFIG_FSL_DDR_INTERACTIVE
3246 Enable interactive DDR debugging. See doc/README.fsl-ddr.
3247
York Sun8ced0502015-01-06 13:18:55 -08003248- CONFIG_FSL_DDR_SYNC_REFRESH
3249 Enable sync of refresh for multiple controllers.
3250
York Sunb6a35f82015-03-19 09:30:28 -07003251- CONFIG_FSL_DDR_BIST
3252 Enable built-in memory test for Freescale DDR controllers.
3253
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003254- CONFIG_SYS_83XX_DDR_USES_CS0
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003255 Only for 83xx systems. If specified, then DDR should
3256 be configured using CS0 and CS1 instead of CS2 and CS3.
Timur Tabi054838e2006-10-31 18:44:42 -06003257
wdenk6203e402004-04-18 10:13:26 +00003258- CONFIG_RMII
3259 Enable RMII mode for all FECs.
3260 Note that this is a global option, we can't
3261 have one FEC in standard MII mode and another in RMII mode.
3262
wdenk20c98a62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00003263- CONFIG_CRC32_VERIFY
3264 Add a verify option to the crc32 command.
3265 The syntax is:
3266
3267 => crc32 -v <address> <count> <crc32>
3268
3269 Where address/count indicate a memory area
3270 and crc32 is the correct crc32 which the
3271 area should have.
3272
wdenk64519362004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003273- CONFIG_LOOPW
3274 Add the "loopw" memory command. This only takes effect if
Simon Glass92ffdee2017-08-04 16:34:27 -06003275 the memory commands are activated globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY).
wdenk64519362004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003276
stroesecc3af832004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003277- CONFIG_MX_CYCLIC
3278 Add the "mdc" and "mwc" memory commands. These are cyclic
3279 "md/mw" commands.
3280 Examples:
3281
wdenk07d7e6b2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003282 => mdc.b 10 4 500
stroesecc3af832004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003283 This command will print 4 bytes (10,11,12,13) each 500 ms.
3284
wdenk07d7e6b2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003285 => mwc.l 100 12345678 10
stroesecc3af832004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003286 This command will write 12345678 to address 100 all 10 ms.
3287
wdenk07d7e6b2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003288 This only takes effect if the memory commands are activated
Simon Glass92ffdee2017-08-04 16:34:27 -06003289 globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY).
stroesecc3af832004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003290
wdenk3d3d99f2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003291- CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT
Rick Chend7e6f922017-12-26 13:55:59 +08003292 [ARM, NDS32, MIPS, RISC-V only] If this variable is defined, then certain
Wolfgang Denk302141d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01003293 low level initializations (like setting up the memory
3294 controller) are omitted and/or U-Boot does not
3295 relocate itself into RAM.
wdenk3d3d99f2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003296
Wolfgang Denk302141d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01003297 Normally this variable MUST NOT be defined. The only
3298 exception is when U-Boot is loaded (to RAM) by some
3299 other boot loader or by a debugger which performs
3300 these initializations itself.
wdenk3d3d99f2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003301
Simon Glass90844072016-05-05 07:28:06 -06003302- CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT_ONLY
3303 [ARM926EJ-S only] This allows just the call to lowlevel_init()
yeongjun Kim7a203682016-07-20 22:56:12 +09003304 to be skipped. The normal CP15 init (such as enabling the
Simon Glass90844072016-05-05 07:28:06 -06003305 instruction cache) is still performed.
3306
Aneesh V552a3192011-07-13 05:11:07 +00003307- CONFIG_SPL_BUILD
Magnus Lilja1ec96d82009-06-13 20:50:00 +02003308 Modifies the behaviour of start.S when compiling a loader
3309 that is executed before the actual U-Boot. E.g. when
3310 compiling a NAND SPL.
wdenk336b2bc2005-04-02 23:52:25 +00003311
Ying Zhang2d2e3b62013-08-16 15:16:15 +08003312- CONFIG_TPL_BUILD
3313 Modifies the behaviour of start.S when compiling a loader
3314 that is executed after the SPL and before the actual U-Boot.
3315 It is loaded by the SPL.
3316
Ying Zhang0d4f5442013-05-20 14:07:23 +08003317- CONFIG_SYS_MPC85XX_NO_RESETVEC
3318 Only for 85xx systems. If this variable is specified, the section
3319 .resetvec is not kept and the section .bootpg is placed in the
3320 previous 4k of the .text section.
3321
Simon Glass17dabf02013-02-24 17:33:14 +00003322- CONFIG_ARCH_MAP_SYSMEM
3323 Generally U-Boot (and in particular the md command) uses
3324 effective address. It is therefore not necessary to regard
3325 U-Boot address as virtual addresses that need to be translated
3326 to physical addresses. However, sandbox requires this, since
3327 it maintains its own little RAM buffer which contains all
3328 addressable memory. This option causes some memory accesses
3329 to be mapped through map_sysmem() / unmap_sysmem().
3330
Simon Glassbfb59802013-02-14 04:18:54 +00003331- CONFIG_X86_RESET_VECTOR
3332 If defined, the x86 reset vector code is included. This is not
3333 needed when U-Boot is running from Coreboot.
Gabe Black14f82462012-11-27 21:08:06 +00003334
Karicheri, Muralidharanc1dc61b2014-04-04 13:16:50 -04003335- CONFIG_SYS_NAND_NO_SUBPAGE_WRITE
3336 Option to disable subpage write in NAND driver
3337 driver that uses this:
Miquel Raynal1f1ae152018-08-16 17:30:07 +02003338 drivers/mtd/nand/raw/davinci_nand.c
Karicheri, Muralidharanc1dc61b2014-04-04 13:16:50 -04003339
Timur Tabi275f4bb2011-11-22 09:21:25 -06003340Freescale QE/FMAN Firmware Support:
3341-----------------------------------
3342
3343The Freescale QUICCEngine (QE) and Frame Manager (FMAN) both support the
3344loading of "firmware", which is encoded in the QE firmware binary format.
3345This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting, so macros
3346are used to identify the storage device (NOR flash, SPI, etc) and the address
3347within that device.
3348
Zhao Qiang83a90842014-03-21 16:21:44 +08003349- CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR
3350 The address in the storage device where the FMAN microcode is located. The
3351 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_IN_xxx macro
3352 is also specified.
3353
3354- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_ADDR
3355 The address in the storage device where the QE microcode is located. The
Timur Tabi275f4bb2011-11-22 09:21:25 -06003356 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_IN_xxx macro
3357 is also specified.
3358
3359- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_LENGTH
3360 The maximum possible size of the firmware. The firmware binary format
3361 has a field that specifies the actual size of the firmware, but it
3362 might not be possible to read any part of the firmware unless some
3363 local storage is allocated to hold the entire firmware first.
3364
3365- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NOR
3366 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NOR flash, mapped as
3367 normal addressable memory via the LBC. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the
3368 virtual address in NOR flash.
3369
3370- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NAND
3371 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NAND flash.
3372 CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the offset within NAND flash.
3373
3374- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_MMC
3375 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SD/MMC
3376 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
3377
Liu Gang1e084582012-03-08 00:33:18 +00003378- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_REMOTE
3379 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in the remote (master)
3380 memory space. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is a virtual address which
Liu Gang357bf5a2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003381 can be mapped from slave TLB->slave LAW->slave SRIO or PCIE outbound
3382 window->master inbound window->master LAW->the ucode address in
3383 master's memory space.
Timur Tabi275f4bb2011-11-22 09:21:25 -06003384
J. German Rivera8ff14b72014-06-23 15:15:55 -07003385Freescale Layerscape Management Complex Firmware Support:
3386---------------------------------------------------------
3387The Freescale Layerscape Management Complex (MC) supports the loading of
3388"firmware".
3389This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting, so macros
3390are used to identify the storage device (NOR flash, SPI, etc) and the address
3391within that device.
3392
3393- CONFIG_FSL_MC_ENET
3394 Enable the MC driver for Layerscape SoCs.
3395
Prabhakar Kushwaha853a9012015-06-02 10:55:52 +05303396Freescale Layerscape Debug Server Support:
3397-------------------------------------------
3398The Freescale Layerscape Debug Server Support supports the loading of
3399"Debug Server firmware" and triggering SP boot-rom.
3400This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting.
3401
York Sun928b6812015-12-07 11:08:58 -08003402- CONFIG_SYS_MC_RSV_MEM_ALIGN
3403 Define alignment of reserved memory MC requires
Prabhakar Kushwaha853a9012015-06-02 10:55:52 +05303404
Paul Kocialkowski7b917022015-07-26 18:48:15 +02003405Reproducible builds
3406-------------------
3407
3408In order to achieve reproducible builds, timestamps used in the U-Boot build
3409process have to be set to a fixed value.
3410
3411This is done using the SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH environment variable.
3412SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH is to be set on the build host's shell, not as a configuration
3413option for U-Boot or an environment variable in U-Boot.
3414
3415SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH should be set to a number of seconds since the epoch, in UTC.
3416
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003417Building the Software:
3418======================
3419
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003420Building U-Boot has been tested in several native build environments
3421and in many different cross environments. Of course we cannot support
3422all possibly existing versions of cross development tools in all
3423(potentially obsolete) versions. In case of tool chain problems we
3424recommend to use the ELDK (see http://www.denx.de/wiki/DULG/ELDK)
3425which is extensively used to build and test U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003426
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003427If you are not using a native environment, it is assumed that you
3428have GNU cross compiling tools available in your path. In this case,
3429you must set the environment variable CROSS_COMPILE in your shell.
3430Note that no changes to the Makefile or any other source files are
3431necessary. For example using the ELDK on a 4xx CPU, please enter:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003432
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003433 $ CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_4xx-
3434 $ export CROSS_COMPILE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003435
Peter Tyserb06976d2009-03-13 18:54:51 -05003436Note: If you wish to generate Windows versions of the utilities in
3437 the tools directory you can use the MinGW toolchain
3438 (http://www.mingw.org). Set your HOST tools to the MinGW
3439 toolchain and execute 'make tools'. For example:
3440
3441 $ make HOSTCC=i586-mingw32msvc-gcc HOSTSTRIP=i586-mingw32msvc-strip tools
3442
3443 Binaries such as tools/mkimage.exe will be created which can
3444 be executed on computers running Windows.
3445
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003446U-Boot is intended to be simple to build. After installing the
3447sources you must configure U-Boot for one specific board type. This
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003448is done by typing:
3449
Holger Freyther7ba4e572014-08-04 09:26:05 +02003450 make NAME_defconfig
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003451
Holger Freyther7ba4e572014-08-04 09:26:05 +02003452where "NAME_defconfig" is the name of one of the existing configu-
Michael Jones5a7fb6f2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00003453rations; see boards.cfg for supported names.
wdenk2f0812d2003-10-08 22:45:44 +00003454
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003455Note: for some board special configuration names may exist; check if
3456 additional information is available from the board vendor; for
3457 instance, the TQM823L systems are available without (standard)
3458 or with LCD support. You can select such additional "features"
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003459 when choosing the configuration, i. e.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003460
Holger Freyther7ba4e572014-08-04 09:26:05 +02003461 make TQM823L_defconfig
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003462 - will configure for a plain TQM823L, i. e. no LCD support
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003463
Holger Freyther7ba4e572014-08-04 09:26:05 +02003464 make TQM823L_LCD_defconfig
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003465 - will configure for a TQM823L with U-Boot console on LCD
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003466
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003467 etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003468
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003469
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003470Finally, type "make all", and you should get some working U-Boot
3471images ready for download to / installation on your system:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003472
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003473- "u-boot.bin" is a raw binary image
3474- "u-boot" is an image in ELF binary format
3475- "u-boot.srec" is in Motorola S-Record format
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003476
Marian Balakowiczefe063f2006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003477By default the build is performed locally and the objects are saved
3478in the source directory. One of the two methods can be used to change
3479this behavior and build U-Boot to some external directory:
3480
34811. Add O= to the make command line invocations:
3482
3483 make O=/tmp/build distclean
Holger Freyther7ba4e572014-08-04 09:26:05 +02003484 make O=/tmp/build NAME_defconfig
Marian Balakowiczefe063f2006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003485 make O=/tmp/build all
3486
Timo Ketolac8c67602014-11-06 14:39:05 +020034872. Set environment variable KBUILD_OUTPUT to point to the desired location:
Marian Balakowiczefe063f2006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003488
Timo Ketolac8c67602014-11-06 14:39:05 +02003489 export KBUILD_OUTPUT=/tmp/build
Marian Balakowiczefe063f2006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003490 make distclean
Holger Freyther7ba4e572014-08-04 09:26:05 +02003491 make NAME_defconfig
Marian Balakowiczefe063f2006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003492 make all
3493
Timo Ketolac8c67602014-11-06 14:39:05 +02003494Note that the command line "O=" setting overrides the KBUILD_OUTPUT environment
Marian Balakowiczefe063f2006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003495variable.
3496
Daniel Schwierzeck88484422018-01-26 16:31:04 +01003497User specific CPPFLAGS, AFLAGS and CFLAGS can be passed to the compiler by
3498setting the according environment variables KCPPFLAGS, KAFLAGS and KCFLAGS.
3499For example to treat all compiler warnings as errors:
3500
3501 make KCFLAGS=-Werror
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003502
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003503Please be aware that the Makefiles assume you are using GNU make, so
3504for instance on NetBSD you might need to use "gmake" instead of
3505native "make".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003506
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003507
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003508If the system board that you have is not listed, then you will need
3509to port U-Boot to your hardware platform. To do this, follow these
3510steps:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003511
Phil Sutterc77b4882015-12-25 14:41:18 +010035121. Create a new directory to hold your board specific code. Add any
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003513 files you need. In your board directory, you will need at least
Phil Sutterc77b4882015-12-25 14:41:18 +01003514 the "Makefile" and a "<board>.c".
35152. Create a new configuration file "include/configs/<board>.h" for
3516 your board.
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +000035173. If you're porting U-Boot to a new CPU, then also create a new
3518 directory to hold your CPU specific code. Add any files you need.
Holger Freyther7ba4e572014-08-04 09:26:05 +020035194. Run "make <board>_defconfig" with your new name.
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +000035205. Type "make", and you should get a working "u-boot.srec" file
3521 to be installed on your target system.
35226. Debug and solve any problems that might arise.
3523 [Of course, this last step is much harder than it sounds.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003524
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003525
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003526Testing of U-Boot Modifications, Ports to New Hardware, etc.:
3527==============================================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003528
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003529If you have modified U-Boot sources (for instance added a new board
3530or support for new devices, a new CPU, etc.) you are expected to
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003531provide feedback to the other developers. The feedback normally takes
3532the form of a "patch", i. e. a context diff against a certain (latest
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003533official or latest in the git repository) version of U-Boot sources.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003534
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003535But before you submit such a patch, please verify that your modifi-
3536cation did not break existing code. At least make sure that *ALL* of
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003537the supported boards compile WITHOUT ANY compiler warnings. To do so,
Simon Glassdc27def2016-07-27 20:33:08 -06003538just run the buildman script (tools/buildman/buildman), which will
3539configure and build U-Boot for ALL supported system. Be warned, this
3540will take a while. Please see the buildman README, or run 'buildman -H'
3541for documentation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003542
Marian Balakowiczefe063f2006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003543
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003544See also "U-Boot Porting Guide" below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003545
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003546
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003547Monitor Commands - Overview:
3548============================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003549
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003550go - start application at address 'addr'
3551run - run commands in an environment variable
3552bootm - boot application image from memory
3553bootp - boot image via network using BootP/TFTP protocol
Marek Vasutcf41a9b2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00003554bootz - boot zImage from memory
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003555tftpboot- boot image via network using TFTP protocol
3556 and env variables "ipaddr" and "serverip"
3557 (and eventually "gatewayip")
Simon Glass6a398d22011-10-24 18:00:07 +00003558tftpput - upload a file via network using TFTP protocol
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003559rarpboot- boot image via network using RARP/TFTP protocol
3560diskboot- boot from IDE devicebootd - boot default, i.e., run 'bootcmd'
3561loads - load S-Record file over serial line
3562loadb - load binary file over serial line (kermit mode)
3563md - memory display
3564mm - memory modify (auto-incrementing)
3565nm - memory modify (constant address)
3566mw - memory write (fill)
3567cp - memory copy
3568cmp - memory compare
3569crc32 - checksum calculation
Peter Tyser469cde42009-04-18 22:34:03 -05003570i2c - I2C sub-system
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003571sspi - SPI utility commands
3572base - print or set address offset
3573printenv- print environment variables
3574setenv - set environment variables
3575saveenv - save environment variables to persistent storage
3576protect - enable or disable FLASH write protection
3577erase - erase FLASH memory
3578flinfo - print FLASH memory information
Karl O. Pinc4baf03d2012-08-03 05:57:21 +00003579nand - NAND memory operations (see doc/README.nand)
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003580bdinfo - print Board Info structure
3581iminfo - print header information for application image
3582coninfo - print console devices and informations
3583ide - IDE sub-system
3584loop - infinite loop on address range
wdenk64519362004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003585loopw - infinite write loop on address range
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003586mtest - simple RAM test
3587icache - enable or disable instruction cache
3588dcache - enable or disable data cache
3589reset - Perform RESET of the CPU
3590echo - echo args to console
3591version - print monitor version
3592help - print online help
3593? - alias for 'help'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003594
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003595
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003596Monitor Commands - Detailed Description:
3597========================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003598
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003599TODO.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003600
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003601For now: just type "help <command>".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003602
3603
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003604Environment Variables:
3605======================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003606
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003607U-Boot supports user configuration using Environment Variables which
3608can be made persistent by saving to Flash memory.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003609
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003610Environment Variables are set using "setenv", printed using
3611"printenv", and saved to Flash using "saveenv". Using "setenv"
3612without a value can be used to delete a variable from the
3613environment. As long as you don't save the environment you are
3614working with an in-memory copy. In case the Flash area containing the
3615environment is erased by accident, a default environment is provided.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003616
Wolfgang Denkb233bd72010-01-17 23:55:53 +01003617Some configuration options can be set using Environment Variables.
3618
3619List of environment variables (most likely not complete):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003620
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003621 baudrate - see CONFIG_BAUDRATE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003622
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003623 bootdelay - see CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003624
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003625 bootcmd - see CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003626
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003627 bootargs - Boot arguments when booting an RTOS image
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003628
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003629 bootfile - Name of the image to load with TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003630
Bartlomiej Siekac5648c82008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003631 bootm_low - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
3632 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
3633 a hexadecimal number and defines lowest address allowed
3634 for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_size"
3635 environment variable. Address defined by "bootm_low" is
3636 also the base of the initial memory mapping for the Linux
Grant Likely26396382011-03-28 09:58:43 +00003637 kernel -- see the description of CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ and
3638 bootm_mapsize.
3639
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003640 bootm_mapsize - Size of the initial memory mapping for the Linux kernel.
Grant Likely26396382011-03-28 09:58:43 +00003641 This variable is given as a hexadecimal number and it
3642 defines the size of the memory region starting at base
3643 address bootm_low that is accessible by the Linux kernel
3644 during early boot. If unset, CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is used
3645 as the default value if it is defined, and bootm_size is
3646 used otherwise.
Bartlomiej Siekac5648c82008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003647
3648 bootm_size - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
3649 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
3650 a hexadecimal number and defines the size of the region
3651 allowed for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_low"
3652 environment variable.
3653
Bartlomiej Siekae273e9f2008-10-01 15:26:31 +02003654 updatefile - Location of the software update file on a TFTP server, used
3655 by the automatic software update feature. Please refer to
3656 documentation in doc/README.update for more details.
3657
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003658 autoload - if set to "no" (any string beginning with 'n'),
3659 "bootp" will just load perform a lookup of the
3660 configuration from the BOOTP server, but not try to
3661 load any image using TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003662
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003663 autostart - if set to "yes", an image loaded using the "bootp",
3664 "rarpboot", "tftpboot" or "diskboot" commands will
3665 be automatically started (by internally calling
3666 "bootm")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003667
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003668 If set to "no", a standalone image passed to the
3669 "bootm" command will be copied to the load address
3670 (and eventually uncompressed), but NOT be started.
3671 This can be used to load and uncompress arbitrary
3672 data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003673
David A. Longd558a4e2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04003674 fdt_high - if set this restricts the maximum address that the
3675 flattened device tree will be copied into upon boot.
Shawn Guo0ca9e982012-01-09 21:54:08 +00003676 For example, if you have a system with 1 GB memory
3677 at physical address 0x10000000, while Linux kernel
3678 only recognizes the first 704 MB as low memory, you
3679 may need to set fdt_high as 0x3C000000 to have the
3680 device tree blob be copied to the maximum address
3681 of the 704 MB low memory, so that Linux kernel can
3682 access it during the boot procedure.
3683
David A. Longd558a4e2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04003684 If this is set to the special value 0xFFFFFFFF then
3685 the fdt will not be copied at all on boot. For this
3686 to work it must reside in writable memory, have
3687 sufficient padding on the end of it for u-boot to
3688 add the information it needs into it, and the memory
3689 must be accessible by the kernel.
3690
Simon Glassdc6fa642011-10-24 19:15:34 +00003691 fdtcontroladdr- if set this is the address of the control flattened
3692 device tree used by U-Boot when CONFIG_OF_CONTROL is
3693 defined.
3694
wdenk0e2bd9c2004-06-06 21:51:03 +00003695 i2cfast - (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
3696 if set to 'y' configures Linux I2C driver for fast
3697 mode (400kHZ). This environment variable is used in
3698 initialization code. So, for changes to be effective
3699 it must be saved and board must be reset.
3700
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003701 initrd_high - restrict positioning of initrd images:
3702 If this variable is not set, initrd images will be
3703 copied to the highest possible address in RAM; this
3704 is usually what you want since it allows for
3705 maximum initrd size. If for some reason you want to
3706 make sure that the initrd image is loaded below the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003707 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ limit, you can set this environment
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003708 variable to a value of "no" or "off" or "0".
3709 Alternatively, you can set it to a maximum upper
3710 address to use (U-Boot will still check that it
3711 does not overwrite the U-Boot stack and data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003712
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003713 For instance, when you have a system with 16 MB
3714 RAM, and want to reserve 4 MB from use by Linux,
3715 you can do this by adding "mem=12M" to the value of
3716 the "bootargs" variable. However, now you must make
3717 sure that the initrd image is placed in the first
3718 12 MB as well - this can be done with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003719
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003720 setenv initrd_high 00c00000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003721
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003722 If you set initrd_high to 0xFFFFFFFF, this is an
3723 indication to U-Boot that all addresses are legal
3724 for the Linux kernel, including addresses in flash
3725 memory. In this case U-Boot will NOT COPY the
3726 ramdisk at all. This may be useful to reduce the
3727 boot time on your system, but requires that this
3728 feature is supported by your Linux kernel.
wdenk3f9ab982003-04-12 23:38:12 +00003729
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003730 ipaddr - IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003731
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003732 loadaddr - Default load address for commands like "bootp",
3733 "rarpboot", "tftpboot", "loadb" or "diskboot"
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003734
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003735 loads_echo - see CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003736
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003737 serverip - TFTP server IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenk6f770ed2003-05-23 23:18:21 +00003738
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003739 bootretry - see CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003740
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003741 bootdelaykey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003742
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003743 bootstopkey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003744
Mike Frysingera23230c2011-10-02 10:01:27 +00003745 ethprime - controls which interface is used first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003746
Mike Frysingera23230c2011-10-02 10:01:27 +00003747 ethact - controls which interface is currently active.
3748 For example you can do the following
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003749
Heiko Schocherc5e84052010-07-20 17:45:02 +02003750 => setenv ethact FEC
3751 => ping 192.168.0.1 # traffic sent on FEC
3752 => setenv ethact SCC
3753 => ping 10.0.0.1 # traffic sent on SCC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003754
Matthias Fuchs204f0ec2008-01-17 07:45:05 +01003755 ethrotate - When set to "no" U-Boot does not go through all
3756 available network interfaces.
3757 It just stays at the currently selected interface.
3758
Wolfgang Denkb233bd72010-01-17 23:55:53 +01003759 netretry - When set to "no" each network operation will
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003760 either succeed or fail without retrying.
3761 When set to "once" the network operation will
3762 fail when all the available network interfaces
3763 are tried once without success.
3764 Useful on scripts which control the retry operation
3765 themselves.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003766
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD1948d6c2009-01-31 09:53:39 +01003767 npe_ucode - set load address for the NPE microcode
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDd2164ef2008-01-07 08:41:34 +01003768
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003769 silent_linux - If set then Linux will be told to boot silently, by
Simon Glass5db3f932013-07-16 20:10:00 -07003770 changing the console to be empty. If "yes" it will be
3771 made silent. If "no" it will not be made silent. If
3772 unset, then it will be made silent if the U-Boot console
3773 is silent.
3774
Albert ARIBAUD \(3ADEV\)83006852015-10-12 00:02:57 +02003775 tftpsrcp - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's
Wolfgang Denke3cfce52005-09-24 22:37:32 +02003776 UDP source port.
3777
Albert ARIBAUD \(3ADEV\)83006852015-10-12 00:02:57 +02003778 tftpdstp - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's UDP
Wolfgang Denk227b5192005-09-24 23:25:46 +02003779 destination port instead of the Well Know Port 69.
3780
Wolfgang Denkb233bd72010-01-17 23:55:53 +01003781 tftpblocksize - Block size to use for TFTP transfers; if not set,
3782 we use the TFTP server's default block size
3783
3784 tftptimeout - Retransmission timeout for TFTP packets (in milli-
3785 seconds, minimum value is 1000 = 1 second). Defines
3786 when a packet is considered to be lost so it has to
3787 be retransmitted. The default is 5000 = 5 seconds.
3788 Lowering this value may make downloads succeed
3789 faster in networks with high packet loss rates or
3790 with unreliable TFTP servers.
3791
Albert ARIBAUD \(3ADEV\)83006852015-10-12 00:02:57 +02003792 tftptimeoutcountmax - maximum count of TFTP timeouts (no
3793 unit, minimum value = 0). Defines how many timeouts
3794 can happen during a single file transfer before that
3795 transfer is aborted. The default is 10, and 0 means
3796 'no timeouts allowed'. Increasing this value may help
3797 downloads succeed with high packet loss rates, or with
3798 unreliable TFTP servers or client hardware.
3799
Wolfgang Denkb233bd72010-01-17 23:55:53 +01003800 vlan - When set to a value < 4095 the traffic over
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003801 Ethernet is encapsulated/received over 802.1q
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003802 VLAN tagged frames.
wdenk145d2c12004-04-15 21:48:45 +00003803
Alexandre Messier15971322016-02-01 17:08:57 -05003804 bootpretryperiod - Period during which BOOTP/DHCP sends retries.
3805 Unsigned value, in milliseconds. If not set, the period will
3806 be either the default (28000), or a value based on
3807 CONFIG_NET_RETRY_COUNT, if defined. This value has
3808 precedence over the valu based on CONFIG_NET_RETRY_COUNT.
3809
Jason Hobbse3fe08e2011-08-31 05:37:28 +00003810The following image location variables contain the location of images
3811used in booting. The "Image" column gives the role of the image and is
3812not an environment variable name. The other columns are environment
3813variable names. "File Name" gives the name of the file on a TFTP
3814server, "RAM Address" gives the location in RAM the image will be
3815loaded to, and "Flash Location" gives the image's address in NOR
3816flash or offset in NAND flash.
3817
3818*Note* - these variables don't have to be defined for all boards, some
Fabio Estevambb7d4972015-04-25 18:53:10 -03003819boards currently use other variables for these purposes, and some
Jason Hobbse3fe08e2011-08-31 05:37:28 +00003820boards use these variables for other purposes.
3821
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003822Image File Name RAM Address Flash Location
3823----- --------- ----------- --------------
3824u-boot u-boot u-boot_addr_r u-boot_addr
3825Linux kernel bootfile kernel_addr_r kernel_addr
3826device tree blob fdtfile fdt_addr_r fdt_addr
3827ramdisk ramdiskfile ramdisk_addr_r ramdisk_addr
Jason Hobbse3fe08e2011-08-31 05:37:28 +00003828
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003829The following environment variables may be used and automatically
3830updated by the network boot commands ("bootp" and "rarpboot"),
3831depending the information provided by your boot server:
wdenk145d2c12004-04-15 21:48:45 +00003832
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003833 bootfile - see above
3834 dnsip - IP address of your Domain Name Server
3835 dnsip2 - IP address of your secondary Domain Name Server
3836 gatewayip - IP address of the Gateway (Router) to use
3837 hostname - Target hostname
3838 ipaddr - see above
3839 netmask - Subnet Mask
3840 rootpath - Pathname of the root filesystem on the NFS server
3841 serverip - see above
wdenk145d2c12004-04-15 21:48:45 +00003842
wdenk145d2c12004-04-15 21:48:45 +00003843
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003844There are two special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003845
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003846 serial# - contains hardware identification information such
3847 as type string and/or serial number
3848 ethaddr - Ethernet address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003849
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003850These variables can be set only once (usually during manufacturing of
3851the board). U-Boot refuses to delete or overwrite these variables
3852once they have been set once.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003853
3854
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003855Further special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003856
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003857 ver - Contains the U-Boot version string as printed
3858 with the "version" command. This variable is
3859 readonly (see CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003860
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003861
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003862Please note that changes to some configuration parameters may take
3863only effect after the next boot (yes, that's just like Windoze :-).
stroeseb9c17c52003-04-04 15:53:41 +00003864
stroeseb9c17c52003-04-04 15:53:41 +00003865
Joe Hershberger60fd3ad2012-12-11 22:16:24 -06003866Callback functions for environment variables:
3867---------------------------------------------
3868
3869For some environment variables, the behavior of u-boot needs to change
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003870when their values are changed. This functionality allows functions to
Joe Hershberger60fd3ad2012-12-11 22:16:24 -06003871be associated with arbitrary variables. On creation, overwrite, or
3872deletion, the callback will provide the opportunity for some side
3873effect to happen or for the change to be rejected.
3874
3875The callbacks are named and associated with a function using the
3876U_BOOT_ENV_CALLBACK macro in your board or driver code.
3877
3878These callbacks are associated with variables in one of two ways. The
3879static list can be added to by defining CONFIG_ENV_CALLBACK_LIST_STATIC
3880in the board configuration to a string that defines a list of
3881associations. The list must be in the following format:
3882
3883 entry = variable_name[:callback_name]
3884 list = entry[,list]
3885
3886If the callback name is not specified, then the callback is deleted.
3887Spaces are also allowed anywhere in the list.
3888
3889Callbacks can also be associated by defining the ".callbacks" variable
3890with the same list format above. Any association in ".callbacks" will
3891override any association in the static list. You can define
3892CONFIG_ENV_CALLBACK_LIST_DEFAULT to a list (string) to define the
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003893".callbacks" environment variable in the default or embedded environment.
Joe Hershberger60fd3ad2012-12-11 22:16:24 -06003894
Joe Hershberger6db9fd42015-05-20 14:27:20 -05003895If CONFIG_REGEX is defined, the variable_name above is evaluated as a
3896regular expression. This allows multiple variables to be connected to
3897the same callback without explicitly listing them all out.
3898
Heinrich Schuchardtc141fa52018-07-29 11:08:14 +02003899The signature of the callback functions is:
3900
3901 int callback(const char *name, const char *value, enum env_op op, int flags)
3902
3903* name - changed environment variable
3904* value - new value of the environment variable
3905* op - operation (create, overwrite, or delete)
3906* flags - attributes of the environment variable change, see flags H_* in
3907 include/search.h
3908
3909The return value is 0 if the variable change is accepted and 1 otherwise.
Joe Hershberger60fd3ad2012-12-11 22:16:24 -06003910
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003911Command Line Parsing:
3912=====================
stroeseb9c17c52003-04-04 15:53:41 +00003913
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003914There are two different command line parsers available with U-Boot:
3915the old "simple" one, and the much more powerful "hush" shell:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003916
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003917Old, simple command line parser:
3918--------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003919
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003920- supports environment variables (through setenv / saveenv commands)
3921- several commands on one line, separated by ';'
Wolfgang Denk86eb3b72005-11-20 21:40:11 +01003922- variable substitution using "... ${name} ..." syntax
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003923- special characters ('$', ';') can be escaped by prefixing with '\',
3924 for example:
Wolfgang Denk86eb3b72005-11-20 21:40:11 +01003925 setenv bootcmd bootm \${address}
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003926- You can also escape text by enclosing in single apostrophes, for example:
3927 setenv addip 'setenv bootargs $bootargs ip=$ipaddr:$serverip:$gatewayip:$netmask:$hostname::off'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003928
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003929Hush shell:
3930-----------
wdenkf4688a22003-05-28 08:06:31 +00003931
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003932- similar to Bourne shell, with control structures like
3933 if...then...else...fi, for...do...done; while...do...done,
3934 until...do...done, ...
3935- supports environment ("global") variables (through setenv / saveenv
3936 commands) and local shell variables (through standard shell syntax
3937 "name=value"); only environment variables can be used with "run"
3938 command
wdenkf4688a22003-05-28 08:06:31 +00003939
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003940General rules:
3941--------------
wdenkf4688a22003-05-28 08:06:31 +00003942
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003943(1) If a command line (or an environment variable executed by a "run"
3944 command) contains several commands separated by semicolon, and
3945 one of these commands fails, then the remaining commands will be
3946 executed anyway.
wdenkf4688a22003-05-28 08:06:31 +00003947
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003948(2) If you execute several variables with one call to run (i. e.
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003949 calling run with a list of variables as arguments), any failing
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003950 command will cause "run" to terminate, i. e. the remaining
3951 variables are not executed.
wdenkf4688a22003-05-28 08:06:31 +00003952
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003953Note for Redundant Ethernet Interfaces:
3954=======================================
wdenkf4688a22003-05-28 08:06:31 +00003955
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003956Some boards come with redundant Ethernet interfaces; U-Boot supports
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003957such configurations and is capable of automatic selection of a
3958"working" interface when needed. MAC assignment works as follows:
wdenkf4688a22003-05-28 08:06:31 +00003959
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003960Network interfaces are numbered eth0, eth1, eth2, ... Corresponding
3961MAC addresses can be stored in the environment as "ethaddr" (=>eth0),
3962"eth1addr" (=>eth1), "eth2addr", ...
wdenkf4688a22003-05-28 08:06:31 +00003963
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003964If the network interface stores some valid MAC address (for instance
3965in SROM), this is used as default address if there is NO correspon-
3966ding setting in the environment; if the corresponding environment
3967variable is set, this overrides the settings in the card; that means:
wdenkf4688a22003-05-28 08:06:31 +00003968
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003969o If the SROM has a valid MAC address, and there is no address in the
3970 environment, the SROM's address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003971
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003972o If there is no valid address in the SROM, and a definition in the
3973 environment exists, then the value from the environment variable is
3974 used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003975
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003976o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and
3977 both addresses are the same, this MAC address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003978
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003979o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and the
3980 addresses differ, the value from the environment is used and a
3981 warning is printed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003982
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003983o If neither SROM nor the environment contain a MAC address, an error
Joe Hershberger2dc2b5d2015-05-04 14:55:13 -05003984 is raised. If CONFIG_NET_RANDOM_ETHADDR is defined, then in this case
3985 a random, locally-assigned MAC is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003986
Ben Warren6db991a2010-04-26 11:11:46 -07003987If Ethernet drivers implement the 'write_hwaddr' function, valid MAC addresses
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003988will be programmed into hardware as part of the initialization process. This
Ben Warren6db991a2010-04-26 11:11:46 -07003989may be skipped by setting the appropriate 'ethmacskip' environment variable.
3990The naming convention is as follows:
3991"ethmacskip" (=>eth0), "eth1macskip" (=>eth1) etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003992
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003993Image Formats:
3994==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003995
Marian Balakowicz18710b82008-03-12 12:13:13 +01003996U-Boot is capable of booting (and performing other auxiliary operations on)
3997images in two formats:
3998
3999New uImage format (FIT)
4000-----------------------
4001
4002Flexible and powerful format based on Flattened Image Tree -- FIT (similar
4003to Flattened Device Tree). It allows the use of images with multiple
4004components (several kernels, ramdisks, etc.), with contents protected by
4005SHA1, MD5 or CRC32. More details are found in the doc/uImage.FIT directory.
4006
4007
4008Old uImage format
4009-----------------
4010
4011Old image format is based on binary files which can be basically anything,
4012preceded by a special header; see the definitions in include/image.h for
4013details; basically, the header defines the following image properties:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004014
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004015* Target Operating System (Provisions for OpenBSD, NetBSD, FreeBSD,
4016 4.4BSD, Linux, SVR4, Esix, Solaris, Irix, SCO, Dell, NCR, VxWorks,
Peter Tyser56b8dd12008-09-08 14:56:49 -05004017 LynxOS, pSOS, QNX, RTEMS, INTEGRITY;
4018 Currently supported: Linux, NetBSD, VxWorks, QNX, RTEMS, LynxOS,
4019 INTEGRITY).
Andy Shevchenko8cb5cdd2017-07-05 16:25:22 +03004020* Target CPU Architecture (Provisions for Alpha, ARM, Intel x86,
Macpaul Lin1cac36e2011-10-19 20:41:11 +00004021 IA64, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC, IBM S390, SuperH, Sparc, Sparc 64 Bit;
Andy Shevchenko8cb5cdd2017-07-05 16:25:22 +03004022 Currently supported: ARM, Intel x86, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC).
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004023* Compression Type (uncompressed, gzip, bzip2)
4024* Load Address
4025* Entry Point
4026* Image Name
4027* Image Timestamp
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004028
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004029The header is marked by a special Magic Number, and both the header
4030and the data portions of the image are secured against corruption by
4031CRC32 checksums.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004032
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004033
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004034Linux Support:
4035==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004036
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004037Although U-Boot should support any OS or standalone application
4038easily, the main focus has always been on Linux during the design of
4039U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004040
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004041U-Boot includes many features that so far have been part of some
4042special "boot loader" code within the Linux kernel. Also, any
4043"initrd" images to be used are no longer part of one big Linux image;
4044instead, kernel and "initrd" are separate images. This implementation
4045serves several purposes:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004046
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004047- the same features can be used for other OS or standalone
4048 applications (for instance: using compressed images to reduce the
4049 Flash memory footprint)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004050
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004051- it becomes much easier to port new Linux kernel versions because
4052 lots of low-level, hardware dependent stuff are done by U-Boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004053
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004054- the same Linux kernel image can now be used with different "initrd"
4055 images; of course this also means that different kernel images can
4056 be run with the same "initrd". This makes testing easier (you don't
4057 have to build a new "zImage.initrd" Linux image when you just
4058 change a file in your "initrd"). Also, a field-upgrade of the
4059 software is easier now.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004060
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004061
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004062Linux HOWTO:
4063============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004064
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004065Porting Linux to U-Boot based systems:
4066---------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004067
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004068U-Boot cannot save you from doing all the necessary modifications to
4069configure the Linux device drivers for use with your target hardware
4070(no, we don't intend to provide a full virtual machine interface to
4071Linux :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004072
Stefan Roese88fbf932010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004073But now you can ignore ALL boot loader code (in arch/powerpc/mbxboot).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004074
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004075Just make sure your machine specific header file (for instance
4076include/asm-ppc/tqm8xx.h) includes the same definition of the Board
Markus Heidelberg47167572008-09-07 20:18:27 +02004077Information structure as we define in include/asm-<arch>/u-boot.h,
4078and make sure that your definition of IMAP_ADDR uses the same value
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004079as your U-Boot configuration in CONFIG_SYS_IMMR.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004080
Simon Glassd097e592014-06-11 23:29:46 -06004081Note that U-Boot now has a driver model, a unified model for drivers.
4082If you are adding a new driver, plumb it into driver model. If there
4083is no uclass available, you are encouraged to create one. See
4084doc/driver-model.
4085
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004086
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004087Configuring the Linux kernel:
4088-----------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004089
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004090No specific requirements for U-Boot. Make sure you have some root
4091device (initial ramdisk, NFS) for your target system.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004092
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004093
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004094Building a Linux Image:
4095-----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004096
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004097With U-Boot, "normal" build targets like "zImage" or "bzImage" are
4098not used. If you use recent kernel source, a new build target
4099"uImage" will exist which automatically builds an image usable by
4100U-Boot. Most older kernels also have support for a "pImage" target,
4101which was introduced for our predecessor project PPCBoot and uses a
4102100% compatible format.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004103
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004104Example:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004105
Holger Freyther7ba4e572014-08-04 09:26:05 +02004106 make TQM850L_defconfig
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004107 make oldconfig
4108 make dep
4109 make uImage
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004110
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004111The "uImage" build target uses a special tool (in 'tools/mkimage') to
4112encapsulate a compressed Linux kernel image with header information,
4113CRC32 checksum etc. for use with U-Boot. This is what we are doing:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004114
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004115* build a standard "vmlinux" kernel image (in ELF binary format):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004116
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004117* convert the kernel into a raw binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004118
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004119 ${CROSS_COMPILE}-objcopy -O binary \
4120 -R .note -R .comment \
4121 -S vmlinux linux.bin
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004122
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004123* compress the binary image:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004124
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004125 gzip -9 linux.bin
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004126
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004127* package compressed binary image for U-Boot:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004128
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004129 mkimage -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip \
4130 -a 0 -e 0 -n "Linux Kernel Image" \
4131 -d linux.bin.gz uImage
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004132
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004133
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004134The "mkimage" tool can also be used to create ramdisk images for use
4135with U-Boot, either separated from the Linux kernel image, or
4136combined into one file. "mkimage" encapsulates the images with a 64
4137byte header containing information about target architecture,
4138operating system, image type, compression method, entry points, time
4139stamp, CRC32 checksums, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004140
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004141"mkimage" can be called in two ways: to verify existing images and
4142print the header information, or to build new images.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004143
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004144In the first form (with "-l" option) mkimage lists the information
4145contained in the header of an existing U-Boot image; this includes
4146checksum verification:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004147
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004148 tools/mkimage -l image
4149 -l ==> list image header information
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004150
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004151The second form (with "-d" option) is used to build a U-Boot image
4152from a "data file" which is used as image payload:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004153
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004154 tools/mkimage -A arch -O os -T type -C comp -a addr -e ep \
4155 -n name -d data_file image
4156 -A ==> set architecture to 'arch'
4157 -O ==> set operating system to 'os'
4158 -T ==> set image type to 'type'
4159 -C ==> set compression type 'comp'
4160 -a ==> set load address to 'addr' (hex)
4161 -e ==> set entry point to 'ep' (hex)
4162 -n ==> set image name to 'name'
4163 -d ==> use image data from 'datafile'
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004164
wdenkcd914452004-05-29 16:53:29 +00004165Right now, all Linux kernels for PowerPC systems use the same load
4166address (0x00000000), but the entry point address depends on the
4167kernel version:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004168
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004169- 2.2.x kernels have the entry point at 0x0000000C,
4170- 2.3.x and later kernels have the entry point at 0x00000000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004171
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004172So a typical call to build a U-Boot image would read:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004173
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004174 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
4175 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roese88fbf932010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004176 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz \
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004177 > examples/uImage.TQM850L
4178 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4179 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4180 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4181 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
4182 Load Address: 0x00000000
4183 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004184
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004185To verify the contents of the image (or check for corruption):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004186
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004187 -> tools/mkimage -l examples/uImage.TQM850L
4188 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4189 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4190 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4191 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
4192 Load Address: 0x00000000
4193 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004194
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004195NOTE: for embedded systems where boot time is critical you can trade
4196speed for memory and install an UNCOMPRESSED image instead: this
4197needs more space in Flash, but boots much faster since it does not
4198need to be uncompressed:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004199
Stefan Roese88fbf932010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004200 -> gunzip /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004201 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
4202 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C none -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roese88fbf932010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004203 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux \
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004204 > examples/uImage.TQM850L-uncompressed
4205 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4206 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4207 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (uncompressed)
4208 Data Size: 792160 Bytes = 773.59 kB = 0.76 MB
4209 Load Address: 0x00000000
4210 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004211
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004212
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004213Similar you can build U-Boot images from a 'ramdisk.image.gz' file
4214when your kernel is intended to use an initial ramdisk:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004215
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004216 -> tools/mkimage -n 'Simple Ramdisk Image' \
4217 > -A ppc -O linux -T ramdisk -C gzip \
4218 > -d /LinuxPPC/images/SIMPLE-ramdisk.image.gz examples/simple-initrd
4219 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4220 Created: Wed Jan 12 14:01:50 2000
4221 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4222 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553.25 kB = 0.54 MB
4223 Load Address: 0x00000000
4224 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004225
Guilherme Maciel Ferreira51553812013-12-01 12:43:11 -07004226The "dumpimage" is a tool to disassemble images built by mkimage. Its "-i"
4227option performs the converse operation of the mkimage's second form (the "-d"
4228option). Given an image built by mkimage, the dumpimage extracts a "data file"
4229from the image:
4230
Guilherme Maciel Ferreira40bf5632015-01-15 02:54:40 -02004231 tools/dumpimage -i image -T type -p position data_file
4232 -i ==> extract from the 'image' a specific 'data_file'
4233 -T ==> set image type to 'type'
4234 -p ==> 'position' (starting at 0) of the 'data_file' inside the 'image'
Guilherme Maciel Ferreira51553812013-12-01 12:43:11 -07004235
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004236
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004237Installing a Linux Image:
4238-------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004239
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004240To downloading a U-Boot image over the serial (console) interface,
4241you must convert the image to S-Record format:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004242
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004243 objcopy -I binary -O srec examples/image examples/image.srec
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004244
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004245The 'objcopy' does not understand the information in the U-Boot
4246image header, so the resulting S-Record file will be relative to
4247address 0x00000000. To load it to a given address, you need to
4248specify the target address as 'offset' parameter with the 'loads'
4249command.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004250
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004251Example: install the image to address 0x40100000 (which on the
4252TQM8xxL is in the first Flash bank):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004253
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004254 => erase 40100000 401FFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004255
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004256 .......... done
4257 Erased 8 sectors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004258
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004259 => loads 40100000
4260 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
4261 ~>examples/image.srec
4262 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 ...
4263 ...
4264 15989 15990 15991 15992
4265 [file transfer complete]
4266 [connected]
4267 ## Start Addr = 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004268
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004269
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004270You can check the success of the download using the 'iminfo' command;
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004271this includes a checksum verification so you can be sure no data
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004272corruption happened:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004273
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004274 => imi 40100000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004275
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004276 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
4277 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4278 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4279 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4280 Load Address: 00000000
4281 Entry Point: 0000000c
4282 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004283
4284
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004285Boot Linux:
4286-----------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004287
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004288The "bootm" command is used to boot an application that is stored in
4289memory (RAM or Flash). In case of a Linux kernel image, the contents
4290of the "bootargs" environment variable is passed to the kernel as
4291parameters. You can check and modify this variable using the
4292"printenv" and "setenv" commands:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004293
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004294
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004295 => printenv bootargs
4296 bootargs=root=/dev/ram
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004297
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004298 => setenv bootargs root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004299
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004300 => printenv bootargs
4301 bootargs=root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004302
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004303 => bootm 40020000
4304 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40020000 ...
4305 Image Name: 2.2.13 for NFS on TQM850L
4306 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4307 Data Size: 381681 Bytes = 372 kB = 0 MB
4308 Load Address: 00000000
4309 Entry Point: 0000000c
4310 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4311 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4312 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:35:17 MEST 2000
4313 Boot arguments: root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
4314 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
4315 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
4316 Memory: 15208k available (700k kernel code, 444k data, 32k init) [c0000000,c1000000]
4317 ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004318
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004319If you want to boot a Linux kernel with initial RAM disk, you pass
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004320the memory addresses of both the kernel and the initrd image (PPBCOOT
4321format!) to the "bootm" command:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004322
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004323 => imi 40100000 40200000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004324
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004325 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
4326 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4327 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4328 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4329 Load Address: 00000000
4330 Entry Point: 0000000c
4331 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004332
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004333 ## Checking Image at 40200000 ...
4334 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4335 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4336 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
4337 Load Address: 00000000
4338 Entry Point: 00000000
4339 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004340
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004341 => bootm 40100000 40200000
4342 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40100000 ...
4343 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4344 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4345 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4346 Load Address: 00000000
4347 Entry Point: 0000000c
4348 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4349 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4350 ## Loading RAMDisk Image at 40200000 ...
4351 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4352 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4353 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
4354 Load Address: 00000000
4355 Entry Point: 00000000
4356 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4357 Loading Ramdisk ... OK
4358 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:32:08 MEST 2000
4359 Boot arguments: root=/dev/ram
4360 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
4361 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
4362 ...
4363 RAMDISK: Compressed image found at block 0
4364 VFS: Mounted root (ext2 filesystem).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004365
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004366 bash#
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004367
Matthew McClintockefae4ca2006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004368Boot Linux and pass a flat device tree:
4369-----------
4370
4371First, U-Boot must be compiled with the appropriate defines. See the section
4372titled "Linux Kernel Interface" above for a more in depth explanation. The
4373following is an example of how to start a kernel and pass an updated
4374flat device tree:
4375
4376=> print oftaddr
4377oftaddr=0x300000
4378=> print oft
4379oft=oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb
4380=> tftp $oftaddr $oft
4381Speed: 1000, full duplex
4382Using TSEC0 device
4383TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.101
4384Filename 'oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb'.
4385Load address: 0x300000
4386Loading: #
4387done
4388Bytes transferred = 4106 (100a hex)
4389=> tftp $loadaddr $bootfile
4390Speed: 1000, full duplex
4391Using TSEC0 device
4392TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.2
4393Filename 'uImage'.
4394Load address: 0x200000
4395Loading:############
4396done
4397Bytes transferred = 1029407 (fb51f hex)
4398=> print loadaddr
4399loadaddr=200000
4400=> print oftaddr
4401oftaddr=0x300000
4402=> bootm $loadaddr - $oftaddr
4403## Booting image at 00200000 ...
Wolfgang Denk018147d2006-11-27 15:32:42 +01004404 Image Name: Linux-2.6.17-dirty
4405 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4406 Data Size: 1029343 Bytes = 1005.2 kB
Matthew McClintockefae4ca2006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004407 Load Address: 00000000
Wolfgang Denk018147d2006-11-27 15:32:42 +01004408 Entry Point: 00000000
Matthew McClintockefae4ca2006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004409 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4410 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4411Booting using flat device tree at 0x300000
4412Using MPC85xx ADS machine description
4413Memory CAM mapping: CAM0=256Mb, CAM1=256Mb, CAM2=0Mb residual: 0Mb
4414[snip]
4415
4416
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004417More About U-Boot Image Types:
4418------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004419
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004420U-Boot supports the following image types:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004421
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004422 "Standalone Programs" are directly runnable in the environment
4423 provided by U-Boot; it is expected that (if they behave
4424 well) you can continue to work in U-Boot after return from
4425 the Standalone Program.
4426 "OS Kernel Images" are usually images of some Embedded OS which
4427 will take over control completely. Usually these programs
4428 will install their own set of exception handlers, device
4429 drivers, set up the MMU, etc. - this means, that you cannot
4430 expect to re-enter U-Boot except by resetting the CPU.
4431 "RAMDisk Images" are more or less just data blocks, and their
4432 parameters (address, size) are passed to an OS kernel that is
4433 being started.
4434 "Multi-File Images" contain several images, typically an OS
4435 (Linux) kernel image and one or more data images like
4436 RAMDisks. This construct is useful for instance when you want
4437 to boot over the network using BOOTP etc., where the boot
4438 server provides just a single image file, but you want to get
4439 for instance an OS kernel and a RAMDisk image.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004440
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004441 "Multi-File Images" start with a list of image sizes, each
4442 image size (in bytes) specified by an "uint32_t" in network
4443 byte order. This list is terminated by an "(uint32_t)0".
4444 Immediately after the terminating 0 follow the images, one by
4445 one, all aligned on "uint32_t" boundaries (size rounded up to
4446 a multiple of 4 bytes).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004447
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004448 "Firmware Images" are binary images containing firmware (like
4449 U-Boot or FPGA images) which usually will be programmed to
4450 flash memory.
wdenk4fc95692003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004451
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004452 "Script files" are command sequences that will be executed by
4453 U-Boot's command interpreter; this feature is especially
4454 useful when you configure U-Boot to use a real shell (hush)
4455 as command interpreter.
wdenk4fc95692003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004456
Marek Vasutcf41a9b2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00004457Booting the Linux zImage:
4458-------------------------
4459
4460On some platforms, it's possible to boot Linux zImage. This is done
4461using the "bootz" command. The syntax of "bootz" command is the same
4462as the syntax of "bootm" command.
4463
Tom Rini45f46d12013-05-16 11:40:11 -04004464Note, defining the CONFIG_SUPPORT_RAW_INITRD allows user to supply
Marek Vasut28850d02012-03-18 11:47:58 +00004465kernel with raw initrd images. The syntax is slightly different, the
4466address of the initrd must be augmented by it's size, in the following
4467format: "<initrd addres>:<initrd size>".
4468
stroeseb9c17c52003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004469
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004470Standalone HOWTO:
4471=================
stroeseb9c17c52003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004472
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004473One of the features of U-Boot is that you can dynamically load and
4474run "standalone" applications, which can use some resources of
4475U-Boot like console I/O functions or interrupt services.
stroeseb9c17c52003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004476
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004477Two simple examples are included with the sources:
wdenk4fc95692003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004478
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004479"Hello World" Demo:
4480-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004481
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004482'examples/hello_world.c' contains a small "Hello World" Demo
4483application; it is automatically compiled when you build U-Boot.
4484It's configured to run at address 0x00040004, so you can play with it
4485like that:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004486
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004487 => loads
4488 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
4489 ~>examples/hello_world.srec
4490 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
4491 [file transfer complete]
4492 [connected]
4493 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004494
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004495 => go 40004 Hello World! This is a test.
4496 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
4497 Hello World
4498 argc = 7
4499 argv[0] = "40004"
4500 argv[1] = "Hello"
4501 argv[2] = "World!"
4502 argv[3] = "This"
4503 argv[4] = "is"
4504 argv[5] = "a"
4505 argv[6] = "test."
4506 argv[7] = "<NULL>"
4507 Hit any key to exit ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004508
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004509 ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004510
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004511Another example, which demonstrates how to register a CPM interrupt
4512handler with the U-Boot code, can be found in 'examples/timer.c'.
4513Here, a CPM timer is set up to generate an interrupt every second.
4514The interrupt service routine is trivial, just printing a '.'
4515character, but this is just a demo program. The application can be
4516controlled by the following keys:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004517
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004518 ? - print current values og the CPM Timer registers
4519 b - enable interrupts and start timer
4520 e - stop timer and disable interrupts
4521 q - quit application
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004522
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004523 => loads
4524 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
4525 ~>examples/timer.srec
4526 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
4527 [file transfer complete]
4528 [connected]
4529 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004530
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004531 => go 40004
4532 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
4533 TIMERS=0xfff00980
4534 Using timer 1
4535 tgcr @ 0xfff00980, tmr @ 0xfff00990, trr @ 0xfff00994, tcr @ 0xfff00998, tcn @ 0xfff0099c, ter @ 0xfff009b0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004536
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004537Hit 'b':
4538 [q, b, e, ?] Set interval 1000000 us
4539 Enabling timer
4540Hit '?':
4541 [q, b, e, ?] ........
4542 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0xef6, ter=0x0
4543Hit '?':
4544 [q, b, e, ?] .
4545 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x2ad4, ter=0x0
4546Hit '?':
4547 [q, b, e, ?] .
4548 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x1efc, ter=0x0
4549Hit '?':
4550 [q, b, e, ?] .
4551 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x169d, ter=0x0
4552Hit 'e':
4553 [q, b, e, ?] ...Stopping timer
4554Hit 'q':
4555 [q, b, e, ?] ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004556
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004557
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004558Minicom warning:
4559================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004560
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004561Over time, many people have reported problems when trying to use the
4562"minicom" terminal emulation program for serial download. I (wd)
4563consider minicom to be broken, and recommend not to use it. Under
4564Unix, I recommend to use C-Kermit for general purpose use (and
4565especially for kermit binary protocol download ("loadb" command), and
Karl O. Pinca0189bb2012-10-01 05:11:56 +00004566use "cu" for S-Record download ("loads" command). See
4567http://www.denx.de/wiki/view/DULG/SystemSetup#Section_4.3.
4568for help with kermit.
4569
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004570
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004571Nevertheless, if you absolutely want to use it try adding this
4572configuration to your "File transfer protocols" section:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004573
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004574 Name Program Name U/D FullScr IO-Red. Multi
4575 X kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -s Y U Y N N
4576 Y kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -r N D Y N N
wdenk8dba0502003-03-31 16:34:49 +00004577
wdenk8dba0502003-03-31 16:34:49 +00004578
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004579NetBSD Notes:
4580=============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004581
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004582Starting at version 0.9.2, U-Boot supports NetBSD both as host
4583(build U-Boot) and target system (boots NetBSD/mpc8xx).
wdenk88e72a32003-06-19 23:04:19 +00004584
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004585Building requires a cross environment; it is known to work on
4586NetBSD/i386 with the cross-powerpc-netbsd-1.3 package (you will also
4587need gmake since the Makefiles are not compatible with BSD make).
4588Note that the cross-powerpc package does not install include files;
4589attempting to build U-Boot will fail because <machine/ansi.h> is
4590missing. This file has to be installed and patched manually:
wdenk88e72a32003-06-19 23:04:19 +00004591
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004592 # cd /usr/pkg/cross/powerpc-netbsd/include
4593 # mkdir powerpc
4594 # ln -s powerpc machine
4595 # cp /usr/src/sys/arch/powerpc/include/ansi.h powerpc/ansi.h
4596 # ${EDIT} powerpc/ansi.h ## must remove __va_list, _BSD_VA_LIST
wdenk88e72a32003-06-19 23:04:19 +00004597
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004598Native builds *don't* work due to incompatibilities between native
4599and U-Boot include files.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004600
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004601Booting assumes that (the first part of) the image booted is a
4602stage-2 loader which in turn loads and then invokes the kernel
4603proper. Loader sources will eventually appear in the NetBSD source
4604tree (probably in sys/arc/mpc8xx/stand/u-boot_stage2/); in the
wdenkd0245fc2005-04-13 10:02:42 +00004605meantime, see ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/ppcboot_stage2.tar.gz
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004606
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004607
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004608Implementation Internals:
4609=========================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004610
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004611The following is not intended to be a complete description of every
4612implementation detail. However, it should help to understand the
4613inner workings of U-Boot and make it easier to port it to custom
4614hardware.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004615
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004616
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004617Initial Stack, Global Data:
4618---------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004619
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004620The implementation of U-Boot is complicated by the fact that U-Boot
4621starts running out of ROM (flash memory), usually without access to
4622system RAM (because the memory controller is not initialized yet).
4623This means that we don't have writable Data or BSS segments, and BSS
4624is not initialized as zero. To be able to get a C environment working
4625at all, we have to allocate at least a minimal stack. Implementation
4626options for this are defined and restricted by the CPU used: Some CPU
4627models provide on-chip memory (like the IMMR area on MPC8xx and
4628MPC826x processors), on others (parts of) the data cache can be
4629locked as (mis-) used as memory, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004630
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004631 Chris Hallinan posted a good summary of these issues to the
Wolfgang Denk290ae6b2008-12-30 22:56:11 +01004632 U-Boot mailing list:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004633
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004634 Subject: RE: [U-Boot-Users] RE: More On Memory Bank x (nothingness)?
4635 From: "Chris Hallinan" <clh@net1plus.com>
4636 Date: Mon, 10 Feb 2003 16:43:46 -0500 (22:43 MET)
4637 ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004638
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004639 Correct me if I'm wrong, folks, but the way I understand it
4640 is this: Using DCACHE as initial RAM for Stack, etc, does not
4641 require any physical RAM backing up the cache. The cleverness
4642 is that the cache is being used as a temporary supply of
4643 necessary storage before the SDRAM controller is setup. It's
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004644 beyond the scope of this list to explain the details, but you
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004645 can see how this works by studying the cache architecture and
4646 operation in the architecture and processor-specific manuals.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004647
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004648 OCM is On Chip Memory, which I believe the 405GP has 4K. It
4649 is another option for the system designer to use as an
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004650 initial stack/RAM area prior to SDRAM being available. Either
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004651 option should work for you. Using CS 4 should be fine if your
4652 board designers haven't used it for something that would
4653 cause you grief during the initial boot! It is frequently not
4654 used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004655
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004656 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR should be somewhere that won't interfere
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004657 with your processor/board/system design. The default value
4658 you will find in any recent u-boot distribution in
Stefan Roese3e1f1b32005-08-01 16:49:12 +02004659 walnut.h should work for you. I'd set it to a value larger
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004660 than your SDRAM module. If you have a 64MB SDRAM module, set
4661 it above 400_0000. Just make sure your board has no resources
4662 that are supposed to respond to that address! That code in
4663 start.S has been around a while and should work as is when
4664 you get the config right.
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004665
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004666 -Chris Hallinan
4667 DS4.COM, Inc.
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004668
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004669It is essential to remember this, since it has some impact on the C
4670code for the initialization procedures:
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004671
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004672* Initialized global data (data segment) is read-only. Do not attempt
4673 to write it.
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004674
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004675* Do not use any uninitialized global data (or implicitly initialized
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004676 as zero data - BSS segment) at all - this is undefined, initiali-
4677 zation is performed later (when relocating to RAM).
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004678
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004679* Stack space is very limited. Avoid big data buffers or things like
4680 that.
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004681
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004682Having only the stack as writable memory limits means we cannot use
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004683normal global data to share information between the code. But it
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004684turned out that the implementation of U-Boot can be greatly
4685simplified by making a global data structure (gd_t) available to all
4686functions. We could pass a pointer to this data as argument to _all_
4687functions, but this would bloat the code. Instead we use a feature of
4688the GCC compiler (Global Register Variables) to share the data: we
4689place a pointer (gd) to the global data into a register which we
4690reserve for this purpose.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004691
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004692When choosing a register for such a purpose we are restricted by the
4693relevant (E)ABI specifications for the current architecture, and by
4694GCC's implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004695
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004696For PowerPC, the following registers have specific use:
4697 R1: stack pointer
Wolfgang Denk69c09642008-02-14 22:43:22 +01004698 R2: reserved for system use
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004699 R3-R4: parameter passing and return values
4700 R5-R10: parameter passing
4701 R13: small data area pointer
4702 R30: GOT pointer
4703 R31: frame pointer
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004704
Joakim Tjernlund693c0c12010-01-19 14:41:58 +01004705 (U-Boot also uses R12 as internal GOT pointer. r12
4706 is a volatile register so r12 needs to be reset when
4707 going back and forth between asm and C)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004708
Wolfgang Denk69c09642008-02-14 22:43:22 +01004709 ==> U-Boot will use R2 to hold a pointer to the global data
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004710
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004711 Note: on PPC, we could use a static initializer (since the
4712 address of the global data structure is known at compile time),
4713 but it turned out that reserving a register results in somewhat
4714 smaller code - although the code savings are not that big (on
4715 average for all boards 752 bytes for the whole U-Boot image,
4716 624 text + 127 data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004717
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004718On ARM, the following registers are used:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004719
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004720 R0: function argument word/integer result
4721 R1-R3: function argument word
Jeroen Hofsteea556aca2013-09-21 14:04:42 +02004722 R9: platform specific
4723 R10: stack limit (used only if stack checking is enabled)
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004724 R11: argument (frame) pointer
4725 R12: temporary workspace
4726 R13: stack pointer
4727 R14: link register
4728 R15: program counter
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004729
Jeroen Hofsteea556aca2013-09-21 14:04:42 +02004730 ==> U-Boot will use R9 to hold a pointer to the global data
4731
4732 Note: on ARM, only R_ARM_RELATIVE relocations are supported.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004733
Thomas Chou8fa38582010-05-21 11:08:03 +08004734On Nios II, the ABI is documented here:
4735 http://www.altera.com/literature/hb/nios2/n2cpu_nii51016.pdf
4736
4737 ==> U-Boot will use gp to hold a pointer to the global data
4738
4739 Note: on Nios II, we give "-G0" option to gcc and don't use gp
4740 to access small data sections, so gp is free.
4741
Macpaul Lin1cac36e2011-10-19 20:41:11 +00004742On NDS32, the following registers are used:
4743
4744 R0-R1: argument/return
4745 R2-R5: argument
4746 R15: temporary register for assembler
4747 R16: trampoline register
4748 R28: frame pointer (FP)
4749 R29: global pointer (GP)
4750 R30: link register (LP)
4751 R31: stack pointer (SP)
4752 PC: program counter (PC)
4753
4754 ==> U-Boot will use R10 to hold a pointer to the global data
4755
Wolfgang Denk6405a152006-03-31 18:32:53 +02004756NOTE: DECLARE_GLOBAL_DATA_PTR must be used with file-global scope,
4757or current versions of GCC may "optimize" the code too much.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004758
Rick Chend7e6f922017-12-26 13:55:59 +08004759On RISC-V, the following registers are used:
4760
4761 x0: hard-wired zero (zero)
4762 x1: return address (ra)
4763 x2: stack pointer (sp)
4764 x3: global pointer (gp)
4765 x4: thread pointer (tp)
4766 x5: link register (t0)
4767 x8: frame pointer (fp)
4768 x10-x11: arguments/return values (a0-1)
4769 x12-x17: arguments (a2-7)
4770 x28-31: temporaries (t3-6)
4771 pc: program counter (pc)
4772
4773 ==> U-Boot will use gp to hold a pointer to the global data
4774
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004775Memory Management:
4776------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004777
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004778U-Boot runs in system state and uses physical addresses, i.e. the
4779MMU is not used either for address mapping nor for memory protection.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004780
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004781The available memory is mapped to fixed addresses using the memory
4782controller. In this process, a contiguous block is formed for each
4783memory type (Flash, SDRAM, SRAM), even when it consists of several
4784physical memory banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004785
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004786U-Boot is installed in the first 128 kB of the first Flash bank (on
4787TQM8xxL modules this is the range 0x40000000 ... 0x4001FFFF). After
4788booting and sizing and initializing DRAM, the code relocates itself
4789to the upper end of DRAM. Immediately below the U-Boot code some
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004790memory is reserved for use by malloc() [see CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004791configuration setting]. Below that, a structure with global Board
4792Info data is placed, followed by the stack (growing downward).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004793
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004794Additionally, some exception handler code is copied to the low 8 kB
4795of DRAM (0x00000000 ... 0x00001FFF).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004796
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004797So a typical memory configuration with 16 MB of DRAM could look like
4798this:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004799
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004800 0x0000 0000 Exception Vector code
4801 :
4802 0x0000 1FFF
4803 0x0000 2000 Free for Application Use
4804 :
4805 :
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004806
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004807 :
4808 :
4809 0x00FB FF20 Monitor Stack (Growing downward)
4810 0x00FB FFAC Board Info Data and permanent copy of global data
4811 0x00FC 0000 Malloc Arena
4812 :
4813 0x00FD FFFF
4814 0x00FE 0000 RAM Copy of Monitor Code
4815 ... eventually: LCD or video framebuffer
4816 ... eventually: pRAM (Protected RAM - unchanged by reset)
4817 0x00FF FFFF [End of RAM]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004818
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004819
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004820System Initialization:
4821----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004822
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004823In the reset configuration, U-Boot starts at the reset entry point
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004824(on most PowerPC systems at address 0x00000100). Because of the reset
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004825configuration for CS0# this is a mirror of the on board Flash memory.
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004826To be able to re-map memory U-Boot then jumps to its link address.
4827To be able to implement the initialization code in C, a (small!)
4828initial stack is set up in the internal Dual Ported RAM (in case CPUs
Heiko Schocher71cb3e92017-06-07 17:33:10 +02004829which provide such a feature like), or in a locked part of the data
4830cache. After that, U-Boot initializes the CPU core, the caches and
4831the SIU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004832
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004833Next, all (potentially) available memory banks are mapped using a
4834preliminary mapping. For example, we put them on 512 MB boundaries
4835(multiples of 0x20000000: SDRAM on 0x00000000 and 0x20000000, Flash
4836on 0x40000000 and 0x60000000, SRAM on 0x80000000). Then UPM A is
4837programmed for SDRAM access. Using the temporary configuration, a
4838simple memory test is run that determines the size of the SDRAM
4839banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004840
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004841When there is more than one SDRAM bank, and the banks are of
4842different size, the largest is mapped first. For equal size, the first
4843bank (CS2#) is mapped first. The first mapping is always for address
48440x00000000, with any additional banks following immediately to create
4845contiguous memory starting from 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004846
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004847Then, the monitor installs itself at the upper end of the SDRAM area
4848and allocates memory for use by malloc() and for the global Board
4849Info data; also, the exception vector code is copied to the low RAM
4850pages, and the final stack is set up.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004851
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004852Only after this relocation will you have a "normal" C environment;
4853until that you are restricted in several ways, mostly because you are
4854running from ROM, and because the code will have to be relocated to a
4855new address in RAM.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004856
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004857
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004858U-Boot Porting Guide:
4859----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004860
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004861[Based on messages by Jerry Van Baren in the U-Boot-Users mailing
4862list, October 2002]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004863
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004864
Jerry Van Barenba0687c2009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004865int main(int argc, char *argv[])
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004866{
4867 sighandler_t no_more_time;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004868
Jerry Van Barenba0687c2009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004869 signal(SIGALRM, no_more_time);
4870 alarm(PROJECT_DEADLINE - toSec (3 * WEEK));
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004871
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004872 if (available_money > available_manpower) {
Jerry Van Barenba0687c2009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004873 Pay consultant to port U-Boot;
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004874 return 0;
4875 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004876
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004877 Download latest U-Boot source;
wdenk34b613e2002-12-17 01:51:00 +00004878
Wolfgang Denk290ae6b2008-12-30 22:56:11 +01004879 Subscribe to u-boot mailing list;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004880
Jerry Van Barenba0687c2009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004881 if (clueless)
4882 email("Hi, I am new to U-Boot, how do I get started?");
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004883
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004884 while (learning) {
4885 Read the README file in the top level directory;
Jerry Van Barenba0687c2009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004886 Read http://www.denx.de/twiki/bin/view/DULG/Manual;
4887 Read applicable doc/*.README;
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004888 Read the source, Luke;
Jerry Van Barenba0687c2009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004889 /* find . -name "*.[chS]" | xargs grep -i <keyword> */
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004890 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004891
Jerry Van Barenba0687c2009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004892 if (available_money > toLocalCurrency ($2500))
4893 Buy a BDI3000;
4894 else
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004895 Add a lot of aggravation and time;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004896
Jerry Van Barenba0687c2009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004897 if (a similar board exists) { /* hopefully... */
4898 cp -a board/<similar> board/<myboard>
4899 cp include/configs/<similar>.h include/configs/<myboard>.h
4900 } else {
4901 Create your own board support subdirectory;
4902 Create your own board include/configs/<myboard>.h file;
4903 }
4904 Edit new board/<myboard> files
4905 Edit new include/configs/<myboard>.h
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004906
Jerry Van Barenba0687c2009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004907 while (!accepted) {
4908 while (!running) {
4909 do {
4910 Add / modify source code;
4911 } until (compiles);
4912 Debug;
4913 if (clueless)
4914 email("Hi, I am having problems...");
4915 }
4916 Send patch file to the U-Boot email list;
4917 if (reasonable critiques)
4918 Incorporate improvements from email list code review;
4919 else
4920 Defend code as written;
wdenk634d2f72004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004921 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004922
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004923 return 0;
4924}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004925
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004926void no_more_time (int sig)
4927{
4928 hire_a_guru();
4929}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004930
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004931
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004932Coding Standards:
4933-----------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004934
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004935All contributions to U-Boot should conform to the Linux kernel
Baruch Siachb1081252017-12-10 17:34:35 +02004936coding style; see the kernel coding style guide at
4937https://www.kernel.org/doc/html/latest/process/coding-style.html, and the
4938script "scripts/Lindent" in your Linux kernel source directory.
Detlev Zundelaa63d482006-09-01 15:39:02 +02004939
4940Source files originating from a different project (for example the
4941MTD subsystem) are generally exempt from these guidelines and are not
Jeremiah Mahler03f930c2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004942reformatted to ease subsequent migration to newer versions of those
Detlev Zundelaa63d482006-09-01 15:39:02 +02004943sources.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004944
Detlev Zundelaa63d482006-09-01 15:39:02 +02004945Please note that U-Boot is implemented in C (and to some small parts in
4946Assembler); no C++ is used, so please do not use C++ style comments (//)
4947in your code.
wdenkad276f22004-01-04 16:28:35 +00004948
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004949Please also stick to the following formatting rules:
4950- remove any trailing white space
Wolfgang Denk20bd2a62011-07-27 10:59:55 +00004951- use TAB characters for indentation and vertical alignment, not spaces
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004952- make sure NOT to use DOS '\r\n' line feeds
Wolfgang Denk20bd2a62011-07-27 10:59:55 +00004953- do not add more than 2 consecutive empty lines to source files
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004954- do not add trailing empty lines to source files
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004955
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004956Submissions which do not conform to the standards may be returned
4957with a request to reformat the changes.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004958
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004959
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004960Submitting Patches:
4961-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004962
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004963Since the number of patches for U-Boot is growing, we need to
4964establish some rules. Submissions which do not conform to these rules
4965may be rejected, even when they contain important and valuable stuff.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004966
Magnus Liljaf3b287b2008-08-06 19:32:33 +02004967Please see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/Patches for details.
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004968
Wolfgang Denk290ae6b2008-12-30 22:56:11 +01004969Patches shall be sent to the u-boot mailing list <u-boot@lists.denx.de>;
S. Lockwood-Childsda6d34c2017-11-14 22:56:42 -08004970see https://lists.denx.de/listinfo/u-boot
Wolfgang Denk290ae6b2008-12-30 22:56:11 +01004971
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004972When you send a patch, please include the following information with
4973it:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004974
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004975* For bug fixes: a description of the bug and how your patch fixes
4976 this bug. Please try to include a way of demonstrating that the
4977 patch actually fixes something.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004978
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004979* For new features: a description of the feature and your
4980 implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004981
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004982* A CHANGELOG entry as plaintext (separate from the patch)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004983
Robert P. J. Day076ed9b2015-12-19 07:16:10 -05004984* For major contributions, add a MAINTAINERS file with your
4985 information and associated file and directory references.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004986
Albert ARIBAUD48e910f2013-09-11 15:52:51 +02004987* When you add support for a new board, don't forget to add a
4988 maintainer e-mail address to the boards.cfg file, too.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004989
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004990* If your patch adds new configuration options, don't forget to
4991 document these in the README file.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004992
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004993* The patch itself. If you are using git (which is *strongly*
4994 recommended) you can easily generate the patch using the
Wolfgang Denk20bd2a62011-07-27 10:59:55 +00004995 "git format-patch". If you then use "git send-email" to send it to
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004996 the U-Boot mailing list, you will avoid most of the common problems
4997 with some other mail clients.
wdenkca9bc762003-07-15 07:45:49 +00004998
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004999 If you cannot use git, use "diff -purN OLD NEW". If your version of
5000 diff does not support these options, then get the latest version of
5001 GNU diff.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005002
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005003 The current directory when running this command shall be the parent
5004 directory of the U-Boot source tree (i. e. please make sure that
5005 your patch includes sufficient directory information for the
5006 affected files).
5007
5008 We prefer patches as plain text. MIME attachments are discouraged,
5009 and compressed attachments must not be used.
wdenk88e72a32003-06-19 23:04:19 +00005010
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005011* If one logical set of modifications affects or creates several
5012 files, all these changes shall be submitted in a SINGLE patch file.
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00005013
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005014* Changesets that contain different, unrelated modifications shall be
5015 submitted as SEPARATE patches, one patch per changeset.
wdenk88e72a32003-06-19 23:04:19 +00005016
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005017
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005018Notes:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005019
Simon Glassdc27def2016-07-27 20:33:08 -06005020* Before sending the patch, run the buildman script on your patched
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005021 source tree and make sure that no errors or warnings are reported
5022 for any of the boards.
5023
5024* Keep your modifications to the necessary minimum: A patch
5025 containing several unrelated changes or arbitrary reformats will be
5026 returned with a request to re-formatting / split it.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005027
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005028* If you modify existing code, make sure that your new code does not
5029 add to the memory footprint of the code ;-) Small is beautiful!
5030 When adding new features, these should compile conditionally only
5031 (using #ifdef), and the resulting code with the new feature
5032 disabled must not need more memory than the old code without your
5033 modification.
wdenkcbc49a52005-05-03 14:12:25 +00005034
Wolfgang Denk290ae6b2008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005035* Remember that there is a size limit of 100 kB per message on the
5036 u-boot mailing list. Bigger patches will be moderated. If they are
5037 reasonable and not too big, they will be acknowledged. But patches
5038 bigger than the size limit should be avoided.